blob: 3a74c7f73d0ff6db1492d0a38aaf8b2103fc88dd [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner4ee451d2007-12-29 20:36:04 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG. This pass is where
12// algebraic simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000042#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +000043#include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000044#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
46#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000047#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +000048#include "llvm/Support/ConstantRange.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000049#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000050#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000051#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000052#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000053#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnera4f0b3a2006-08-27 12:54:02 +000054#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000058#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000059#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000060#include <algorithm>
Torok Edwin3eaee312008-04-20 08:33:11 +000061#include <climits>
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000062#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000063using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000064using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000065
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000066STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
67STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
68STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
69STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
70STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000071
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000072namespace {
Chris Lattnerf4b54612006-06-28 22:08:15 +000073 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
74 : public FunctionPass,
75 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000076 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000077 std::vector<Instruction*> Worklist;
78 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000079 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000080 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000081 public:
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +000082 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +000083 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass((intptr_t)&ID) {}
84
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000085 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
86 /// isn't already in it.
87 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
Dan Gohman6b345ee2008-07-07 17:46:23 +000088 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())).second)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000089 Worklist.push_back(I);
90 }
91
92 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
93 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
94 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
95 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
96
97 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
98 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
99
100 WorklistMap.erase(It);
101 }
102
103 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
104 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
105 Worklist.pop_back();
106 WorklistMap.erase(I);
107 return I;
108 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000109
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000110
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000111 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
112 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
113 /// now.
114 ///
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000115 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000116 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000117 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000118 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000119 }
120
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000121 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
122 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
123 ///
124 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000125 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
126 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000127 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000128 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000129
130 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
131 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
132 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
133 ///
134 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
135 ///
136 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
137 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
138
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000139 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
140 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i)) {
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000141 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000142 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000143 *i = UndefValue::get(Op->getType());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000144 }
145
146 return R;
147 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000148
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000149 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000150 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000151
152 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000153
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000154 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000155 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000156 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000157 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000158 }
159
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000160 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
161
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000162 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
163 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
164 // Return Value:
165 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000166 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000167 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000168 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000169 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
170 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
171 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000172 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
174 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +0000175 bool SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000176 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
177 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000178 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
179 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
180 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
182 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000183 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
184 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
185 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000186 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
187 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
188 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
189 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +0000190 Instruction *FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I, Instruction *LHSI,
191 Constant *RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000192 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
193 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
194 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000195 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
196 Instruction *LHS,
197 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000198 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
199 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000200
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000201 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
202 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000203 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000204 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000205 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
206 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000207 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000208 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
209 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
210 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +0000211 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000212 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +0000213 Instruction *visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI);
214 Instruction *visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000215 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
216 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
217 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +0000218 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000219 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000220 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
221 Instruction *FI);
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +0000222 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &CI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000223 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
224 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000225 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
226 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000227 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000228 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000229 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000230 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000231 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000232 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000233 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000234 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000235 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000236 Instruction *visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000237
238 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000239 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000240
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000241 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000242 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000243 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000244 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +0000245 Instruction *transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
246 bool DoXform = true);
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +0000247 bool WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000248
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000249 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000250 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
251 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
252 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000253 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000254 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
255 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000256 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
257 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000258 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000259 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000260 }
261
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000262 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
263 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
264 /// cast.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000265 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
266 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000267 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000268
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000269 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000270 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000271
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000272 Instruction *C = CastInst::Create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000273 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000274 return C;
275 }
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +0000276
277 Value *InsertBitCastBefore(Value *V, const Type *Ty, Instruction &Pos) {
278 return InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, V, Ty, Pos);
279 }
280
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000281
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000282 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
283 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
284 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
285 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
286 // modified.
287 //
288 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000289 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000290 if (&I != V) {
291 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
292 return &I;
293 } else {
294 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
295 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000296 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000297 return &I;
298 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000299 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000300
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000301 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
302 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
303 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
304 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
305 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
306 //
307 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
308 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
309 if (Old != New)
310 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
311 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000312 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000313 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000314 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000315 return true;
316 }
317
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000318 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
319 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
320 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
321 // this function.
322 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
323 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
324 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000325 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000326 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000327 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
328 }
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +0000329
330 void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt &KnownZero,
331 APInt &KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
332 return llvm::ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, TD, Depth);
333 }
334
335 bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt &Mask,
336 unsigned Depth = 0) const {
337 return llvm::MaskedValueIsZero(V, Mask, TD, Depth);
338 }
339 unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(Value *Op, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
340 return llvm::ComputeNumSignBits(Op, TD, Depth);
341 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000342
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000343 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000344 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
345 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
346 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
347 ///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000348 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
349 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000350 Instruction *InsertBefore);
351
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000352 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
353 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000354 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000355
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000356 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
357 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
358 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
359
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000360 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
361 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000362 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
363 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
364 unsigned Depth = 0);
365
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000366 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
367 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
368
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000369 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
370 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
371 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
372 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
373
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000374 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
375 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
376 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
377 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000378 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
379
380
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000381 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
382 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000383
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000384 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000385 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000386 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000387 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000388 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000389 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000390 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000391 Instruction *SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +0000392 Instruction *SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000393
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000394
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000395 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000396
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000397 bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
398 unsigned CastOpc,
399 int &NumCastsRemoved);
400 unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
401 unsigned PrefAlign = 0);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000402
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000403 };
404}
405
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +0000406char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
407static RegisterPass<InstCombiner>
408X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
409
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000410// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000411// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000412static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
413 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
414 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000415 return 3;
416 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000417 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000418 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
419 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000420}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000421
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000422// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
423// it.
424static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000425 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000426}
427
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000428// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
429// though a va_arg area...
430static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000431 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
432 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
433 return Type::Int32Ty;
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000434 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000435 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000436}
437
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000438/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst or a constant
439/// expression bitcast, return the operand value, otherwise return null.
440static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
441 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000442 return I->getOperand(0);
443 else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000444 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000445 return CE->getOperand(0);
446 return 0;
447}
448
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000449/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
450/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000451static Instruction::CastOps
452isEliminableCastPair(
453 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
454 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
455 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
456 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
457) {
458
459 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
460 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000461
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000462 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
463 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
464 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000465
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000466 return Instruction::CastOps(
467 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
468 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000469}
470
471/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
472/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
473/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000474static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
475 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000476 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
477
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000478 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000479 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000480 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000481 return false;
482 return true;
483}
484
485/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
486/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
487/// casts that are known to not do anything...
488///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000489Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
490 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000491 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
492 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
493 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000494 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000495
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000496 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000497}
498
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000499// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
500// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000501//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000502// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
503// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
504// binary operators.
505//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000506// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
507// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000508//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000509bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000510 bool Changed = false;
511 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
512 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000513
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000514 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
515 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000516 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
517 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
518 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000519 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
520 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
521 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000522 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
523 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
524 return true;
525 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
526 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
527 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
528 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
529 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
530
531 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000532 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000533 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::Create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000534 Op1->getOperand(0),
535 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000536 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000537 I.setOperand(0, New);
538 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
539 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000540 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000541 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000542 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000543}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000544
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000545/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
546/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
547/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
548bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
549 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
550 return false;
551 I.swapOperands();
552 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
553 return true;
554}
555
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000556// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
557// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000558//
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000559static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
560 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000561 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000562
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000563 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
564 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
565 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000566
567 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
568 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isInteger())
569 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
570
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000571 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000572}
573
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000574static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
575 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000576 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000577
578 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000579 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000580 return ConstantInt::get(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000581 return 0;
582}
583
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000584// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
585// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000586// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
587// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000588//
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000589static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000590 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000591 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000592 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000593 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000594 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000595 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000596 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000597 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000598 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000599 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000600 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000601 return I->getOperand(0);
602 }
603 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000604 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000605}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000606
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000607/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
608/// expression, return it.
609static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
610 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
611 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
612 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
613 return cast<User>(V);
614 return false;
615}
616
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000617/// getOpcode - If this is an Instruction or a ConstantExpr, return the
618/// opcode value. Otherwise return UserOp1.
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000619static unsigned getOpcode(const Value *V) {
620 if (const Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000621 return I->getOpcode();
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000622 if (const ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000623 return CE->getOpcode();
624 // Use UserOp1 to mean there's no opcode.
625 return Instruction::UserOp1;
626}
627
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000628/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000629static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000630 APInt Val(C->getValue());
631 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000632}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000633/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000634static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000635 APInt Val(C->getValue());
636 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000637}
638/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
639static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
640 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
641}
642/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
643static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
644 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
645}
646/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
647static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
648 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
649}
650/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
651static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
652 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000653}
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000654/// MultiplyOverflows - True if the multiply can not be expressed in an int
655/// this size.
656static bool MultiplyOverflows(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2, bool sign) {
657 uint32_t W = C1->getBitWidth();
658 APInt LHSExt = C1->getValue(), RHSExt = C2->getValue();
659 if (sign) {
660 LHSExt.sext(W * 2);
661 RHSExt.sext(W * 2);
662 } else {
663 LHSExt.zext(W * 2);
664 RHSExt.zext(W * 2);
665 }
666
667 APInt MulExt = LHSExt * RHSExt;
668
669 if (sign) {
670 APInt Min = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W).sext(W * 2);
671 APInt Max = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(W).sext(W * 2);
672 return MulExt.slt(Min) || MulExt.sgt(Max);
673 } else
674 return MulExt.ugt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(W * 2, W));
675}
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000676
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000677
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000678/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
679/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
680/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
681/// constant and return true.
682static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000683 APInt Demanded) {
684 assert(I && "No instruction?");
685 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
686
687 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
688 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
689 if (!OpC) return false;
690
691 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
692 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
693 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
694 return false;
695
696 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
697 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
698 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
699 return true;
700}
701
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000702// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
703// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
704// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
705// min/max.
706static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000707 const APInt& KnownZero,
708 const APInt& KnownOne,
709 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
710 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
711 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
712 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
713 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
714 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000715 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000716
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000717 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
718 // bit if it is unknown.
719 Min = KnownOne;
720 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
721
Zhou Sheng4acf1552007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000722 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000723 Min.set(BitWidth-1);
724 Max.clear(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000725 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000726}
727
728// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
729// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
730// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
731// min/max.
732static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000733 const APInt &KnownZero,
734 const APInt &KnownOne,
735 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
736 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth(); BitWidth = BitWidth;
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000737 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
738 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
739 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
740 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000741 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000742
743 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
744 Min = KnownOne;
745 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
746 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
747}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000748
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000749/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
750/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
751/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
752/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
753/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
754/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
755/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
756/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
757/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
758/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
759/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
760/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
761/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
762/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
763/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
764bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
765 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
766 unsigned Depth) {
767 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
768 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
769 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
770 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
771 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
772 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
773 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
774 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
775 must have same BitWidth");
776 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
777 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
778 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
779 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
780 return false;
781 }
782
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000783 KnownZero.clear();
784 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000785 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
786 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
787 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
788 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
789 return false;
790 }
791 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
792 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
793 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
794 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
795 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
796 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
797 return false;
798 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
799 return false;
800 }
801
802 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
803 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
804
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000805 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
806 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
807 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000808 default:
809 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
810 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000811 case Instruction::And:
812 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
813 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
814 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
815 return true;
816 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
817 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
818
819 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
820 // LHS.
821 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
822 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
823 return true;
824 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
825 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
826
827 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
828 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
829 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
830 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
831 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
832 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
833 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
834 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
835
836 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
837 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
838 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
839
840 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
841 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
842 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
843
844 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
845 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
846 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
847 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
848 break;
849 case Instruction::Or:
850 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
851 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
852 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
853 return true;
854 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
855 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
856 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
857 // LHS.
858 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
859 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
860 return true;
861 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
862 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
863
864 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
865 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
866 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
867 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
868 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
869 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
870 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
871 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
872
873 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
874 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
875 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
876 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
877 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
878 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
879 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
880 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
881
882 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
883 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
884 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
885
886 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
887 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
888 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
889 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
890 break;
891 case Instruction::Xor: {
892 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
893 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
894 return true;
895 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
896 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
897 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
898 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
899 return true;
900 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
901 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
902
903 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
904 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
905 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
906 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
907 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
908 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
909
910 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
911 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
912 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
913 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
914 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
915 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
916
917 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
918 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
919 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
920 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
921 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000922 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000923 I->getName());
924 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
925 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
926 }
927
928 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
929 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
930 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
931 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
932 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
933 // all known
934 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
935 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
936 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000937 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000938 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
939 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
940 }
941 }
942
943 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
944 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
945 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
946 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
947
948 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
949 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
950 break;
951 }
952 case Instruction::Select:
953 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
954 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
955 return true;
956 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
957 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
958 return true;
959 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
960 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
961 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
962 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
963
964 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
965 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
966 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
967 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
968 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
969
970 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
971 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
972 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
973 break;
974 case Instruction::Trunc: {
975 uint32_t truncBf =
976 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +0000977 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
978 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
979 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
980 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
981 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000982 return true;
983 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
984 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
985 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
986 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
987 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
988 break;
989 }
990 case Instruction::BitCast:
991 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
992 return false;
993
994 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
995 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
996 return true;
997 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
998 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
999 break;
1000 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1001 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1002 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001003 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001004
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001005 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1006 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1007 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001008 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1009 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001010 return true;
1011 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1012 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1013 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1014 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1015 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1016 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001017 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001018 break;
1019 }
1020 case Instruction::SExt: {
1021 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1022 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001023 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001024
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001025 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001026 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001027
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001028 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001029 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1030 // bit is demanded.
1031 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001032 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001033
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001034 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1035 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1036 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001037 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1038 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001039 return true;
1040 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1041 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1042 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1043 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1044 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1045
1046 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1047 // top bits of the result.
1048
1049 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1050 // convert this into a zero extension.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001051 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001052 {
1053 // Convert to ZExt cast
1054 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1055 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001056 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001057 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001058 }
1059 break;
1060 }
1061 case Instruction::Add: {
1062 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1063 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1064 // either.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001065 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001066
1067 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1068 // we can do.
1069 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1070 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1071 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1072 if (RHS->isZero())
1073 break;
1074
1075 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1076 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001077 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001078
1079 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1080 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1081 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1082 return true;
1083
1084 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1085 // the constant.
1086 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1087 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1088
1089 // Avoid excess work.
1090 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1091 break;
1092
1093 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1094 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1095 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001096 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001097 I->getName());
1098 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1099 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1100 }
1101
1102 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1103 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1104 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1105 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1106 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1107
1108 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1109 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1110 // this scan.
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001111 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1112 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001113
1114 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1115
1116 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1117 // other, and there is no input carry.
1118 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1119 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1120
1121 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1122 // is no input carry.
1123 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1124 } else {
1125 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1126 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001127 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001128 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1129 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001130 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001131 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1132 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1133 return true;
1134 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1135 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1136 return true;
1137 }
1138 }
1139 break;
1140 }
1141 case Instruction::Sub:
1142 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1143 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001144 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001145 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1146 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001147 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001148 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001149 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1150 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1151 return true;
1152 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1153 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1154 return true;
1155 }
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001156 // Otherwise just hand the sub off to ComputeMaskedBits to fill in
1157 // the known zeros and ones.
1158 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001159 break;
1160 case Instruction::Shl:
1161 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001162 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001163 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1164 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001165 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1166 return true;
1167 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1168 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1169 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1170 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1171 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001172 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001173 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001174 }
1175 break;
1176 case Instruction::LShr:
1177 // For a logical shift right
1178 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001179 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001180
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001181 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001182 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1183 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001184 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1185 return true;
1186 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1187 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001188 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1189 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001190 if (ShiftAmt) {
1191 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001192 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001193 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1194 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001195 }
1196 break;
1197 case Instruction::AShr:
1198 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1199 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1200 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1201 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1202 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1203 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001204 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001205 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1206 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1207 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1208 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001209
1210 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1211 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1212 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
1213 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001214
1215 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001216 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001217
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001218 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001219 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001220 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1221 // demanded.
1222 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1223 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001224 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001225 DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001226 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1227 return true;
1228 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1229 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1230 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001231 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001232 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1233 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1234
1235 // Handle the sign bits.
1236 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1237 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1238 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1239
1240 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1241 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shengcc419402008-06-06 08:32:05 +00001242 if (BitWidth <= ShiftAmt || RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001243 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1244 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001245 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001246 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1247 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1248 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1249 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1250 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1251 }
1252 }
1253 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001254 case Instruction::SRem:
1255 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1256 APInt RA = Rem->getValue();
1257 if (RA.isPowerOf2() || (-RA).isPowerOf2()) {
Nick Lewycky3ac9e102008-07-12 05:04:38 +00001258 if (DemandedMask.ule(RA)) // srem won't affect demanded bits
1259 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1260
Dan Gohman23e1df82008-05-06 00:51:48 +00001261 APInt LowBits = RA.isStrictlyPositive() ? (RA - 1) : ~RA;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001262 APInt Mask2 = LowBits | APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
1263 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2,
1264 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1265 return true;
1266
1267 if (LHSKnownZero[BitWidth-1] || ((LHSKnownZero & LowBits) == LowBits))
1268 LHSKnownZero |= ~LowBits;
1269 else if (LHSKnownOne[BitWidth-1])
1270 LHSKnownOne |= ~LowBits;
1271
1272 KnownZero |= LHSKnownZero & DemandedMask;
1273 KnownOne |= LHSKnownOne & DemandedMask;
1274
1275 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1276 }
1277 }
1278 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001279 case Instruction::URem: {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001280 APInt KnownZero2(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne2(BitWidth, 0);
1281 APInt AllOnes = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001282 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), AllOnes,
1283 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1284 return true;
1285
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001286 uint32_t Leaders = KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes();
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001287 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), AllOnes,
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001288 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1289 return true;
1290
1291 Leaders = std::max(Leaders,
1292 KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes());
1293 KnownZero = APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, Leaders) & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001294 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001295 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001296 case Instruction::Call:
1297 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
1298 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1299 default: break;
1300 case Intrinsic::bswap: {
1301 // If the only bits demanded come from one byte of the bswap result,
1302 // just shift the input byte into position to eliminate the bswap.
1303 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1304 unsigned NTZ = DemandedMask.countTrailingZeros();
1305
1306 // Round NTZ down to the next byte. If we have 11 trailing zeros, then
1307 // we need all the bits down to bit 8. Likewise, round NLZ. If we
1308 // have 14 leading zeros, round to 8.
1309 NLZ &= ~7;
1310 NTZ &= ~7;
1311 // If we need exactly one byte, we can do this transformation.
1312 if (BitWidth-NLZ-NTZ == 8) {
1313 unsigned ResultBit = NTZ;
1314 unsigned InputBit = BitWidth-NTZ-8;
1315
1316 // Replace this with either a left or right shift to get the byte into
1317 // the right place.
1318 Instruction *NewVal;
1319 if (InputBit > ResultBit)
1320 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(I->getOperand(1),
1321 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), InputBit-ResultBit));
1322 else
1323 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I->getOperand(1),
1324 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), ResultBit-InputBit));
1325 NewVal->takeName(I);
1326 InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
1327 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1328 }
1329
1330 // TODO: Could compute known zero/one bits based on the input.
1331 break;
1332 }
1333 }
1334 }
Chris Lattner6c3bfba2008-06-18 18:11:55 +00001335 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001336 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001337 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001338
1339 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1340 // constant.
1341 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1342 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1343 return false;
1344}
1345
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001346
1347/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value producecs a vector with
1348/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1349/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1350/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1351///
1352/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1353/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1354/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1355Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1356 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1357 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001358 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001359 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1360 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
1361 assert(DemandedElts != EltMask && (DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 &&
1362 "Invalid DemandedElts!");
1363
1364 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1365 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1366 UndefElts = EltMask;
1367 return 0;
1368 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1369 UndefElts = EltMask;
1370 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1371 }
1372
1373 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001374 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1375 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001376 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1377
1378 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1379 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1380 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1381 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1382 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1383 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1384 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1385 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1386 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1387 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1388 }
1389
1390 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001391 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001392 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1393 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001394 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001395 // set to undef.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001396 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001397 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1398 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1399 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1400 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1401 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1402 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001403 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001404 }
1405
1406 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
1407 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
1408 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1409 return false;
1410 }
1411 return false;
1412 } else if (Depth == 10) { // Limit search depth.
1413 return false;
1414 }
1415
1416 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1417 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1418
1419 bool MadeChange = false;
1420 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1421 Value *TmpV;
1422 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1423 default: break;
1424
1425 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1426 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1427 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001428 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001429 if (Idx == 0) {
1430 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1431 // which elt is getting updated.
1432 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1433 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1434 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1435 break;
1436 }
1437
1438 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1439 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001440 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001441 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1442 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1443
1444 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1445 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1446 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1447 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1448 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1449 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1450
1451 // The inserted element is defined.
1452 UndefElts |= 1ULL << IdxNo;
1453 break;
1454 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001455 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001456 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001457 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1458 if (!VTy) break;
1459 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
1460 uint64_t InputDemandedElts = 0;
1461 unsigned Ratio;
1462
1463 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001464 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001465 // elements as are demanded of us.
1466 Ratio = 1;
1467 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1468 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1469 // Untested so far.
1470 break;
1471
1472 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1473 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1474 // elements are live.
1475 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1476 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
1477 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << OutIdx))
1478 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio);
1479 }
1480 } else {
1481 // Untested so far.
1482 break;
1483
1484 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1485 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1486 // live.
1487 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1488 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1489 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << InIdx/Ratio))
1490 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << InIdx;
1491 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001492
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001493 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1494 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1495 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1496 if (TmpV) {
1497 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1498 MadeChange = true;
1499 }
1500
1501 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1502 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1503 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1504 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1505 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1506 // undef.
1507 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
1508 if (UndefElts2 & (1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio)))
1509 UndefElts |= 1ULL << OutIdx;
1510 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
1511 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1512 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1513 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1514 // elements are undef.
1515 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1516 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1517 if ((UndefElts2 & (1ULL << InIdx)) == 0) // Not undef?
1518 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << (InIdx/Ratio)); // Clear undef bit.
1519 }
1520 break;
1521 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001522 case Instruction::And:
1523 case Instruction::Or:
1524 case Instruction::Xor:
1525 case Instruction::Add:
1526 case Instruction::Sub:
1527 case Instruction::Mul:
1528 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1529 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1530 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1531 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1532 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1533 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1534 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1535
1536 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1537 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1538 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1539 break;
1540
1541 case Instruction::Call: {
1542 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1543 if (!II) break;
1544 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1545 default: break;
1546
1547 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1548 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1549 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1550 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1551 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1552 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1553 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1554 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1555 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1556 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1557 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1558 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1559 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1560 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1561 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1562 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1563
1564 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1565 // scalarize it now.
1566 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1567 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1568 default: break;
1569 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1570 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1571 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1572 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1573 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1574 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1575 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1576 // Extract the element as scalars.
1577 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1578 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1579
1580 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1581 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1582 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1583 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001584 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001585 II->getName()), *II);
1586 break;
1587 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1588 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001589 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001590 II->getName()), *II);
1591 break;
1592 }
1593
1594 Instruction *New =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001595 InsertElementInst::Create(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1596 II->getName());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001597 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1598 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1599 return New;
1600 }
1601 }
1602
1603 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1604 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1605 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1606 break;
1607 }
1608 break;
1609 }
1610 }
1611 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1612}
1613
Dan Gohman45b4e482008-05-19 22:14:15 +00001614
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001615/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1616/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1617/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1618/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1619/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1620/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1621/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1622///
1623template<typename Functor>
Dan Gohman76d402b2008-05-20 01:14:05 +00001624static Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001625 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1626 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1627
1628 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1629 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1630 return F.apply(Root);
1631
1632 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1633 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001634 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001635 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1636 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1637
1638 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1639 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1640 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1641 ShouldApply = true;
1642 }
1643
1644 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1645 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1646 if (ShouldApply) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001647 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1648 // and perform the reassociation.
1649 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1650
1651 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1652 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1653
1654 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1655 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001656 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001657 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1658 return 0;
1659 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001660 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001661 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001662 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001663 TmpLHSI->moveBefore(ARI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001664 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001665
1666 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1667 // get to LHSI.
1668 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1669 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001670 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1671 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001672 NextLHSI->moveBefore(ARI);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001673 ARI = NextLHSI;
1674
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001675 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1676 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1677 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1678 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1679 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001680
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001681 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1682 // the transformation...
1683 return F.apply(Root);
1684 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001685
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001686 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1687 }
1688 return 0;
1689}
1690
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001691namespace {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001692
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001693// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001694struct AddRHS {
1695 Value *RHS;
1696 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1697 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1698 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001699 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Add.getOperand(0),
1700 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001701 }
1702};
1703
1704// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1705// iff C1&C2 == 0
1706struct AddMaskingAnd {
1707 Constant *C2;
1708 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1709 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001710 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001711 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001712 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001713 }
1714 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001715 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001716 }
1717};
1718
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001719}
1720
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001721static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001722 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001723 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001724 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001725 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001726
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001727 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001728 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001729 }
1730
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001731 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001732 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1733 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001734
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001735 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1736 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001737 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1738 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001739 }
1740
1741 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1742 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1743 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1744 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001745 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001746 New = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001747 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001748 New = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001749 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001750 else {
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001751 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001752 abort();
1753 }
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001754 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1755}
1756
1757// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1758// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1759// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1760// not have a second operand.
1761static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1762 InstCombiner *IC) {
1763 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1764 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1765 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1766 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1767
1768 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001769 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001770 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001771
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001772 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1773 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1774
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001775 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1776 SelectFalseVal);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001777 }
1778 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001779}
1780
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001781
1782/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1783/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1784/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1785Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1786 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001787 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001788 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001789
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001790 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1791 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001792 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001793 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1794 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1795 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1796 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001797 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001798 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1799
1800 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1801 // loop.
1802 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1803 return 0;
1804 }
1805
1806 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1807 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1808 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1809 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1810 if (NonConstBB) {
1811 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1812 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1813 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001814
1815 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001816 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001817 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001818 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001819 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001820
1821 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1822 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1823 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001824 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00001825 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001826 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001827 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1828 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1829 else
1830 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001831 } else {
1832 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1833 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001834 InV = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001835 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1836 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001837 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001838 InV = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001839 CI->getPredicate(),
1840 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1841 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001842 else
1843 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1844
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001845 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001846 }
1847 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001848 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001849 } else {
1850 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1851 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001852 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001853 Value *InV;
1854 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001855 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001856 } else {
1857 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001858 InV = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001859 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1860 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001861 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001862 }
1863 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001864 }
1865 }
1866 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1867}
1868
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001869
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00001870/// WillNotOverflowSignedAdd - Return true if we can prove that:
1871/// (sext (add LHS, RHS)) === (add (sext LHS), (sext RHS))
1872/// This basically requires proving that the add in the original type would not
1873/// overflow to change the sign bit or have a carry out.
1874bool InstCombiner::WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
1875 // There are different heuristics we can use for this. Here are some simple
1876 // ones.
1877
1878 // Add has the property that adding any two 2's complement numbers can only
1879 // have one carry bit which can change a sign. As such, if LHS and RHS each
1880 // have at least two sign bits, we know that the addition of the two values will
1881 // sign extend fine.
1882 if (ComputeNumSignBits(LHS) > 1 && ComputeNumSignBits(RHS) > 1)
1883 return true;
1884
1885
1886 // If one of the operands only has one non-zero bit, and if the other operand
1887 // has a known-zero bit in a more significant place than it (not including the
1888 // sign bit) the ripple may go up to and fill the zero, but won't change the
1889 // sign. For example, (X & ~4) + 1.
1890
1891 // TODO: Implement.
1892
1893 return false;
1894}
1895
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001896
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001897Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001898 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001899 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001900
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001901 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001902 // X + undef -> undef
1903 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1904 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1905
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001906 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001907 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001908 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
1909 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001910 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00001911 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
1912 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001913 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001914 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001915
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001916 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001917 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001918 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001919 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001920 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001921 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001922
1923 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
1924 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001925 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
1926 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
1927 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
1928 KnownZero, KnownOne))
1929 return &I;
1930 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001931 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001932
1933 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
1934 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
1935 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001936
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00001937 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
1938 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00001939 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
1940 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001941 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001942 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001943
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001944 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001945 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
1946 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001947 do {
1948 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001949 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
1950 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001951 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
1952 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001953 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00001954 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
1955 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001956 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001957 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001958 }
1959 }
1960 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001961 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
1962 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
1963 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001964
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00001965 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00001966 // with funny bit widths then this switch statement should be removed. It
1967 // is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back up to something
1968 // that the back ends can handle.
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00001969 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
1970 switch (Size) {
1971 default: break;
1972 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
1973 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
1974 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
1975 }
1976 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00001977 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001978 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00001979 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001980 }
1981 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001982 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001983
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00001984 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
1985 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
1986
Nick Lewycky7d26bd82008-05-23 04:39:38 +00001987 // X + X --> X << 1
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00001988 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001989 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00001990
1991 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
1992 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
1993 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
1994 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
1995 }
1996 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
1997 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
1998 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
1999 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2000 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002001 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002002
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002003 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002004 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
2005 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castNegVal(LHS)) {
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002006 if (LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
2007 if (Value *RHSV = dyn_castNegVal(RHS)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002008 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSV, RHSV, "sum");
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002009 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002010 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(NewAdd);
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002011 }
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002012 }
2013
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002014 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(RHS, LHSV);
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002015 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002016
2017 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002018 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
2019 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002020 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002021
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002022
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002023 ConstantInt *C2;
2024 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
2025 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002026 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002027
2028 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2029 ConstantInt *C1;
2030 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002031 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002032 }
2033
2034 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002035 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002036 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002037
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002038 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00002039 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS || dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
2040 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002041
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002042
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002043 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002044 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002045 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
2046 return R;
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002047
2048 // A+B --> A|B iff A and B have no bits set in common.
2049 if (const IntegerType *IT = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())) {
2050 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(IT->getBitWidth());
2051 APInt LHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2052 APInt LHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2053 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
2054 if (LHSKnownZero != 0) {
2055 APInt RHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2056 APInt RHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2057 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
2058
2059 // No bits in common -> bitwise or.
Chris Lattner9d60ba92008-05-19 20:03:53 +00002060 if ((LHSKnownZero|RHSKnownZero).isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002061 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002062 }
2063 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002064
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002065 // W*X + Y*Z --> W * (X+Z) iff W == Y
Nick Lewycky0c2c3f62008-02-03 08:19:11 +00002066 if (I.getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002067 Value *W, *X, *Y, *Z;
2068 if (match(LHS, m_Mul(m_Value(W), m_Value(X))) &&
2069 match(RHS, m_Mul(m_Value(Y), m_Value(Z)))) {
2070 if (W != Y) {
2071 if (W == Z) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002072 std::swap(Y, Z);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002073 } else if (Y == X) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002074 std::swap(W, X);
2075 } else if (X == Z) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002076 std::swap(Y, Z);
2077 std::swap(W, X);
2078 }
2079 }
2080
2081 if (W == Y) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002082 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, Z,
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002083 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002084 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(W, NewAdd);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002085 }
2086 }
2087 }
2088
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002089 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002090 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002091 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002092 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002093
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002094 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
2095 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002096 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002097 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2098 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2099 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002100 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002101
2102 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002103 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002104
2105 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002106 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002107
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002108 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2109 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002110 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, CRHS,
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002111 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002112 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewAdd, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002113 }
2114 }
2115 }
2116
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002117 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2118 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002119 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002120 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002121 }
2122
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002123 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002124 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) --> intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002125 {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002126 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2127 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002128 if (!CI) {
2129 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2130 Other = LHS;
2131 }
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002132 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002133 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2134 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002135 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00002136 unsigned AS =
2137 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00002138 Value *I2 = InsertBitCastBefore(CI->getOperand(0),
2139 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty, AS), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002140 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(GetElementPtrInst::Create(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002141 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002142 }
2143 }
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002144
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002145 // add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002146 {
2147 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
2148 Value *Other = RHS;
2149 if (!SI) {
2150 SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
2151 Other = LHS;
2152 }
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002153 if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002154 Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
2155 Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002156 Value *A, *N;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002157
2158 // Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
2159 // We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002160 if (match(FV, m_Zero()) && match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2161 A == Other) // Fold the add into the true select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002162 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002163 if (match(TV, m_Zero()) && match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2164 A == Other) // Fold the add into the false select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002165 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002166 }
2167 }
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002168
2169 // Check for X+0.0. Simplify it to X if we know X is not -0.0.
2170 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS))
2171 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isPosZero() && CannotBeNegativeZero(LHS))
2172 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002173
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002174 // Check for (add (sext x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2175 // integer add followed by a sext.
2176 if (SExtInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(LHS)) {
2177 // (add (sext x), cst) --> (sext (add x, cst'))
2178 if (ConstantInt *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
2179 Constant *CI =
2180 ConstantExpr::getTrunc(RHSC, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2181 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2182 ConstantExpr::getSExt(CI, I.getType()) == RHSC &&
2183 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2184 // Insert the new, smaller add.
2185 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2186 CI, "addconv");
2187 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2188 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2189 }
2190 }
2191
2192 // (add (sext x), (sext y)) --> (sext (add int x, y))
2193 if (SExtInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(RHS)) {
2194 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2195 // single use (so we don't increase the number of sexts), and if the
2196 // integer add will not overflow.
2197 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2198 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2199 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2200 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2201 // Insert the new integer add.
2202 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2203 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2204 "addconv");
2205 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2206 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2207 }
2208 }
2209 }
2210
2211 // Check for (add double (sitofp x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2212 // integer add followed by a promotion.
2213 if (SIToFPInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(LHS)) {
2214 // (add double (sitofp x), fpcst) --> (sitofp (add int x, intcst))
2215 // ... if the constant fits in the integer value. This is useful for things
2216 // like (double)(x & 1234) + 4.0 -> (double)((X & 1234)+4) which no longer
2217 // requires a constant pool load, and generally allows the add to be better
2218 // instcombined.
2219 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS)) {
2220 Constant *CI =
2221 ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(CFP, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2222 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2223 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(CI, I.getType()) == CFP &&
2224 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2225 // Insert the new integer add.
2226 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2227 CI, "addconv");
2228 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2229 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2230 }
2231 }
2232
2233 // (add double (sitofp x), (sitofp y)) --> (sitofp (add int x, y))
2234 if (SIToFPInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(RHS)) {
2235 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2236 // single use (so we don't increase the number of int->fp conversions),
2237 // and if the integer add will not overflow.
2238 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2239 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2240 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2241 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2242 // Insert the new integer add.
2243 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2244 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2245 "addconv");
2246 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2247 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2248 }
2249 }
2250 }
2251
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002252 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002253}
2254
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002255Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002256 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002257
Chris Lattnerd137ab42008-07-17 06:07:20 +00002258 if (Op0 == Op1 && // sub X, X -> 0
2259 !I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002260 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002261
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002262 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002263 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002264 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002265
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002266 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2267 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2268 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2269 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2270
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002271 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2272 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002273 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002274 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002275
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002276 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002277 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002278 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002279 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, AddOne(C));
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002280
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002281 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2282 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002283 if (C->isZero()) {
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002284 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002285 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002286 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002287 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002288 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002289 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002290 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002291 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002292 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002293 }
2294 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002295 }
2296 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2297 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2298 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002299 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002300 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002301 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002302 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002303 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002304 }
2305 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002306 }
2307 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002308 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002309
2310 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2311 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002312 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002313 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002314
2315 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2316 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2317 return NV;
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002318 }
2319
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002320 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2321 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
2322
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002323 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2324 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002325 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002326 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002327 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002328 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002329 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002330 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2331 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2332 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002333 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002334 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2335 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002336 }
2337
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002338 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002339 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2340 // is not used by anyone else...
2341 //
Chris Lattner0517e722004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002342 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002343 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002344 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2345 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2346 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2347 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002348
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002349 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002350 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002351 }
2352
2353 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2354 //
2355 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2356 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2357 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2358
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002359 Value *NewNot =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002360 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
2361 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002362 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002363
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002364 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002365 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002366 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002367 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002368 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002369 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002370 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2371
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002372 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002373 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002374 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002375 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002376 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002377 }
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002378
2379 // X - ((X / Y) * Y) --> X % Y
2380 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
2381 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op1I->getOperand(0)))
2382 if (Op0 == I->getOperand(0) &&
2383 Op1I->getOperand(1) == I->getOperand(1)) {
2384 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002385 return BinaryOperator::CreateSRem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002386 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002387 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002388 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002389 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002390 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002391
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002392 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002393 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002394 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002395 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2396 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2397 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2398 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002399 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2400 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002401 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002402 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002403 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002404
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002405 ConstantInt *C1;
2406 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002407 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002408 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002409
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002410 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2411 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002412 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002413 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002414 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002415}
2416
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002417/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2418/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2419/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2420/// signed.
2421static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2422 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002423 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002424 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2425 TrueIfSigned = true;
2426 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002427 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2428 TrueIfSigned = true;
2429 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002430 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2431 TrueIfSigned = false;
2432 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002433 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2434 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2435 TrueIfSigned = true;
2436 return RHS->getValue() ==
2437 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2438 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2439 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2440 TrueIfSigned = true;
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00002441 return RHS->getValue().isSignBit();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002442 default:
2443 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002444 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002445}
2446
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002447Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002448 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002449 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002450
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002451 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2452 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2453
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002454 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002455 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2456 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002457
2458 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002459 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002460 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2461 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002462 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(SI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002463 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002464
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002465 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002466 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2467 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2468 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2469 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002470 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002471
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002472 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002473 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002474 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0,
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002475 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002476 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002477 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002478 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2479 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002480
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002481 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2482 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00002483 // We need a better interface for long double here.
2484 if (Op1->getType() == Type::FloatTy || Op1->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
2485 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2486 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002487 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002488
2489 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2490 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattner47c99092008-05-18 04:11:26 +00002491 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002492 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002493 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002494 Op1, "tmp");
2495 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2496 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2497 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002498 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Add, C1C2);
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002499
2500 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002501
2502 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2503 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002504 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002505 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002506
2507 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2508 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2509 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002510 }
2511
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002512 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2513 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002514 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002515
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002516 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2517 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
2518
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002519 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2520 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2521 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2522 // formed.
2523 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002524 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002525 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002526 BoolCast = CI;
2527 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002528 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002529 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002530 BoolCast = CI;
2531 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002532 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002533 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2534 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002535 bool TIS = false;
2536
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002537 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002538 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2539 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002540 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2541 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002542 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002543 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002544 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002545 Value *V =
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002546 InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002547 BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002548 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2549 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002550
2551 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2552 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002553 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002554 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2555 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002556 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2557 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2558 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2559 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2560 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002561
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002562 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002563 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002564 }
2565 }
2566 }
2567
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002568 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002569}
2570
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002571/// SimplifyDivRemOfSelect - Try to fold a divide or remainder of a select
2572/// instruction.
2573bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I) {
2574 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I.getOperand(1));
2575
2576 // div/rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div/rem X, Y
2577 int NonNullOperand = -1;
2578 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2579 if (ST->isNullValue())
2580 NonNullOperand = 2;
2581 // div/rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div/rem X, Y
2582 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2583 if (ST->isNullValue())
2584 NonNullOperand = 1;
2585
2586 if (NonNullOperand == -1)
2587 return false;
2588
2589 Value *SelectCond = SI->getOperand(0);
2590
2591 // Change the div/rem to use 'Y' instead of the select.
2592 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand));
2593
2594 // Okay, we know we replace the operand of the div/rem with 'Y' with no
2595 // problem. However, the select, or the condition of the select may have
2596 // multiple uses. Based on our knowledge that the operand must be non-zero,
2597 // propagate the known value for the select into other uses of it, and
2598 // propagate a known value of the condition into its other users.
2599
2600 // If the select and condition only have a single use, don't bother with this,
2601 // early exit.
2602 if (SI->use_empty() && SelectCond->hasOneUse())
2603 return true;
2604
2605 // Scan the current block backward, looking for other uses of SI.
2606 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &I, BBFront = I.getParent()->begin();
2607
2608 while (BBI != BBFront) {
2609 --BBI;
2610 // If we found a call to a function, we can't assume it will return, so
2611 // information from below it cannot be propagated above it.
2612 if (isa<CallInst>(BBI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BBI))
2613 break;
2614
2615 // Replace uses of the select or its condition with the known values.
2616 for (Instruction::op_iterator I = BBI->op_begin(), E = BBI->op_end();
2617 I != E; ++I) {
2618 if (*I == SI) {
2619 *I = SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand);
2620 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2621 } else if (*I == SelectCond) {
2622 *I = NonNullOperand == 1 ? ConstantInt::getTrue() :
2623 ConstantInt::getFalse();
2624 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2625 }
2626 }
2627
2628 // If we past the instruction, quit looking for it.
2629 if (&*BBI == SI)
2630 SI = 0;
2631 if (&*BBI == SelectCond)
2632 SelectCond = 0;
2633
2634 // If we ran out of things to eliminate, break out of the loop.
2635 if (SelectCond == 0 && SI == 0)
2636 break;
2637
2638 }
2639 return true;
2640}
2641
2642
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002643/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2644/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2645/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2646/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002647Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002648 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002649
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002650 // undef / X -> 0 for integer.
2651 // undef / X -> undef for FP (the undef could be a snan).
2652 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
2653 if (Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2654 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002655 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002656 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002657
2658 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002659 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002660 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002661
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002662 return 0;
2663}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002664
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002665/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2666/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2667/// division instructions.
2668/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002669Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002670 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2671
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002672 // (sdiv X, X) --> 1 (udiv X, X) --> 1
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002673 if (Op0 == Op1) {
2674 if (const VectorType *Ty = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2675 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(Ty->getElementType(), 1);
2676 std::vector<Constant*> Elts(Ty->getNumElements(), CI);
2677 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
2678 }
2679
2680 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1);
2681 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
2682 }
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002683
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002684 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2685 return Common;
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002686
2687 // Handle cases involving: [su]div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2688 // This does not apply for fdiv.
2689 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2690 return &I;
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002691
2692 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2693 // div X, 1 == X
2694 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2695 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2696
2697 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2698 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2699 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2700 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002701 if (MultiplyOverflows(RHS, LHSRHS, I.getOpcode()==Instruction::SDiv))
2702 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2703 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002704 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002705 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002706 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002707
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002708 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002709 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2710 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2711 return R;
2712 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2713 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2714 return NV;
2715 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002716 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002717
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002718 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002719 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002720 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2721 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2722
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002723 // It can't be division by zero, hence it must be division by one.
2724 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2725 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2726
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002727 return 0;
2728}
2729
2730Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2731 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2732
2733 // Handle the integer div common cases
2734 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2735 return Common;
2736
2737 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2738 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2739 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2740 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002741 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002742 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002743 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002744 }
2745
2746 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002747 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002748 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2749 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002750 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002751 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002752 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002753 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002754 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002755 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002756 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002757 }
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002758 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002759 }
2760 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002761 }
2762
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002763 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2764 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002765 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002766 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002767 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002768 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002769 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002770 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002771 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002772 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2773 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002774 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002775 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2776 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2777
2778 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2779 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002780 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002781 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2782 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002783
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002784 // construct the select instruction and return it.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002785 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002786 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002787 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002788 return 0;
2789}
2790
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002791Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2792 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2793
2794 // Handle the integer div common cases
2795 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2796 return Common;
2797
2798 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2799 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2800 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002801 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002802
2803 // -X/C -> X/-C
2804 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002805 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002806 }
2807
2808 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2809 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002810 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002811 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002812 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002813 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002814 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002815 }
2816 }
2817
2818 return 0;
2819}
2820
2821Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2822 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2823}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002824
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002825/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2826/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2827/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2828/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2829Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002830 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002831
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002832 // 0 % X == 0 for integer, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002833 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2834 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2835 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2836
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002837 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef % X -> 0
2838 if (I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2839 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X % undef -> undef (could be SNaN)
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002840 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002841 }
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002842 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2843 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002844
2845 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002846 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2847 return &I;
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002848
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002849 return 0;
2850}
2851
2852/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2853/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2854/// remainder instructions.
2855/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2856Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2857 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2858
2859 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2860 return common;
2861
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002862 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002863 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2864 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2865 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2866
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002867 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2868 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2869
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002870 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2871 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2872 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2873 return R;
2874 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2875 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2876 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002877 }
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00002878
2879 // See if we can fold away this rem instruction.
2880 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
2881 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
2882 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2883 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2884 return &I;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002885 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002886 }
2887
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002888 return 0;
2889}
2890
2891Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2892 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2893
2894 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2895 return common;
2896
2897 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2898 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
2899 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
2900 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
2901 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002902 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002903 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002904 }
2905
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002906 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002907 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
2908 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2909 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002910 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002911 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002912 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(RHSI, N1,
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002913 "tmp"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002914 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Add);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002915 }
2916 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002917 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002918
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002919 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
2920 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
2921 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2922 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2923 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
2924 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002925 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
2926 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002927 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002928 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002929 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002930 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002931 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002932 }
2933 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002934 }
2935
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002936 return 0;
2937}
2938
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002939Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2940 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2941
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002942 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002943 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2944 return common;
2945
2946 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
2947 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) ||
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002948 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002949 // X % -Y -> X % Y
2950 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
2951 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
2952 return &I;
2953 }
2954
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002955 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002956 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002957 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
2958 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
2959 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2960 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002961 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002962 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002963 }
2964
2965 return 0;
2966}
2967
2968Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002969 return commonRemTransforms(I);
2970}
2971
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002972// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
2973// constant.
2974static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00002975 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002976}
2977
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002978// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
2979// This is the same as lowones(~X).
2980static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00002981 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002982}
2983
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002984/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002985/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
2986///
2987/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
2988///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002989/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
2990/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002991///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002992/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
2993/// 0 A > B
2994/// 1 A == B
2995/// 2 A < B
2996///
2997/// <=> Value Definition
2998/// 000 0 Always false
2999/// 001 1 A > B
3000/// 010 2 A == B
3001/// 011 3 A >= B
3002/// 100 4 A < B
3003/// 101 5 A != B
3004/// 110 6 A <= B
3005/// 111 7 Always true
3006///
3007static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
3008 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003009 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003010 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3011 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
3012 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
3013 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3014 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
3015 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
3016 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
3017 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
3018 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
3019 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003020 // True -> 7
3021 default:
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003022 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003023 return 0;
3024 }
3025}
3026
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003027/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
3028/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00003029/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003030/// of predicate to use in new icmp instructions.
3031static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3032 switch (code) {
3033 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003034 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003035 case 1:
3036 if (sign)
3037 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
3038 else
3039 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
3040 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
3041 case 3:
3042 if (sign)
3043 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
3044 else
3045 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3046 case 4:
3047 if (sign)
3048 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
3049 else
3050 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3051 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
3052 case 6:
3053 if (sign)
3054 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
3055 else
3056 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003057 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003058 }
3059}
3060
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003061static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
3062 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
3063 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) &&
3064 (p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)) ||
3065 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) &&
3066 (p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
3067}
3068
3069namespace {
3070// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3071struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003072 InstCombiner &IC;
3073 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003074 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
3075 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
3076 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
3077 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003078 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003079 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
3080 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003081 return ((ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS) ||
3082 (ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS));
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003083 return false;
3084 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003085 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
3086 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
3087 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
3088 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
3089 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003090 }
3091
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003092 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003093 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003094 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003095 unsigned Code;
3096 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
3097 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
3098 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
3099 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner021c1902003-09-22 20:33:34 +00003100 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003101 }
3102
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003103 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
3104 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
3105
3106 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003107 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
3108 return I;
3109 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3110 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3111 }
3112};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003113} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003114
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003115// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3116// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003117// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003118Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003119 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3120 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003121 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3122 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003123 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003124 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003125 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003126
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003127 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3128 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003129 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003130 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003131 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003132 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003133 And->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003134 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003135 }
3136 break;
3137 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003138 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3139 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003140
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003141 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3142 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003143 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003144 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003145 Or->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003146 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003147 }
3148 break;
3149 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003150 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003151 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3152 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3153 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003154 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003155
3156 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003157 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003158 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3159 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3160 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003161 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003162
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003163 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3164 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3165 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3166 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3167 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3168 // no effect.
3169 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3170 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3171 return &TheAnd;
3172 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003173 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003174 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003175 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003176 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003177 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003178 }
3179 }
3180 }
3181 }
3182 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003183
3184 case Instruction::Shl: {
3185 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3186 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3187 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003188 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003189 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003190 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
3191 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003192
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003193 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3194 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003195 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3196 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003197 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3198 return &TheAnd;
3199 }
3200 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003201 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003202 case Instruction::LShr:
3203 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003204 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3205 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3206 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3207 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003208 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003209 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003210 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3211 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003212
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003213 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3214 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003215 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3216 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3217 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3218 return &TheAnd;
3219 }
3220 break;
3221 }
3222 case Instruction::AShr:
3223 // Signed shr.
3224 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3225 // with an and.
3226 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003227 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003228 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003229 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3230 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003231 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003232 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003233 // Make the argument unsigned.
3234 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003235 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003236 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003237 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003238 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003239 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003240 }
3241 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003242 }
3243 return 0;
3244}
3245
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003246
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003247/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3248/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003249/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3250/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003251/// insert new instructions.
3252Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003253 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3254 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003255 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003256 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003257 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003258
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003259 if (Inside) {
3260 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003261 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003262
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003263 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003264 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003265 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003266 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3267 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3268 }
3269
3270 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3271 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003272 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003273 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003274 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3275 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003276 }
3277
3278 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003279 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003280
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003281 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003282 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003283 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003284 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3285 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3286 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3287 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003288
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003289 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3290 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3291 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003292 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003293 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003294 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3295 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003296}
3297
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003298// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3299// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3300// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3301// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003302static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003303 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003304 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3305 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003306
3307 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003308 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003309 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003310 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003311 return true;
3312}
3313
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003314/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3315/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3316/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003317///
3318/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3319/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3320/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3321///
3322/// return (A +/- B).
3323///
3324Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003325 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003326 Instruction &I) {
3327 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3328 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3329 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3330
3331 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3332
3333 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3334 default: return 0;
3335 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003336 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003337 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003338 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3339 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3340 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003341 break;
3342
3343 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3344 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3345 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003346 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003347 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003348 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003349 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003350 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003351 break;
3352 }
3353 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003354 return 0;
3355 case Instruction::Or:
3356 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003357 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003358 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3359 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003360 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003361 break;
3362 return 0;
3363 }
3364
3365 Instruction *New;
3366 if (isSub)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003367 New = BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003368 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003369 New = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003370 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3371}
3372
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003373Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003374 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003375 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003376
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003377 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3378 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3379
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003380 // and X, X = X
3381 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003382 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003383
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003384 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003385 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003386 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003387 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3388 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3389 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003390 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003391 return &I;
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003392 } else {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003393 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003394 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003395 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003396 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3397 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003398 }
3399 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003400
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003401 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003402 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3403 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003404
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003405 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003406 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003407 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003408 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3409 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3410 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3411 case Instruction::Xor:
3412 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003413 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3414 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3415 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3416 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003417 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003418 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3419 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003420 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003421 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003422 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003423 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003424 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3425 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003426 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003427 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3428 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003429 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003430 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3431 }
3432 }
3433
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003434 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003435 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003436 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3437 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3438 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3439 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003440 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003441 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003442 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003443 break;
3444
3445 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003446 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3447 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3448 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3449 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003450 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003451
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003452 // (A - N) & AndRHS -> -N & AndRHS iff A&AndRHS==0 and AndRHS
3453 // has 1's for all bits that the subtraction with A might affect.
3454 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3455 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHSMask.getBitWidth();
3456 uint32_t Zeros = AndRHSMask.countLeadingZeros();
3457 APInt Mask = APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - Zeros);
3458
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003459 ConstantInt *A = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0LHS);
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003460 if (!(A && A->isZero()) && // avoid infinite recursion.
3461 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, Mask)) {
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003462 Instruction *NewNeg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0RHS);
3463 InsertNewInstBefore(NewNeg, I);
3464 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewNeg, AndRHS);
3465 }
3466 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003467 break;
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003468
3469 case Instruction::Shl:
3470 case Instruction::LShr:
3471 // (1 << x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
3472 // (1 >> x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
Nick Lewyckyd8ad4922008-07-09 07:35:26 +00003473 if (AndRHSMask == 1 && Op0LHS == AndRHS) {
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003474 Instruction *NewICmp = new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0RHS,
3475 Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3476 InsertNewInstBefore(NewICmp, I);
3477 return new ZExtInst(NewICmp, I.getType());
3478 }
3479 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003480 }
3481
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003482 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003483 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003484 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003485 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003486 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3487 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3488 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3489 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003490 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003491 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003492 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003493 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3494 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003495 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3496 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3497 // other simplifications.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003498 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::CreateTruncOrBitCast(
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003499 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3500 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003501 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003502 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003503 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003504 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003505 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewCast, C3);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003506 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3507 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3508 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattnerbb4e7b22006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003509 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003510 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3511 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3512 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003513 }
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003514 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003515 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003516
3517 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3518 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003519 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003520 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003521 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3522 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3523 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003524 }
3525
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003526 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3527 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003528
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003529 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3530 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3531
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003532 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003533 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003534 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003535 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003536 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003537 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Or);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003538 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003539
3540 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003541 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
3542 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003543 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3544 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003545
3546 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
3547 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3548 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003549 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003550 }
3551 }
3552
3553 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003554 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3555 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003556
3557 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
3558 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3559 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003560 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003561 }
3562 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003563
3564 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3565 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3566 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3567 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3568 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3569 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3570 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3571 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3572 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3573 }
3574 }
3575 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3576 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3577 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3578 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3579 std::swap(A, B);
3580 }
3581 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003582 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(B, "tmp");
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003583 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003584 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003585 }
3586 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003587 }
3588
Nick Lewyckyb30591e2008-08-06 04:54:03 +00003589 { // (icmp ult A, C) & (icmp ult B, C) --> (icmp ult (A|B), C)
3590 // where C is a power of 2
3591 Value *A, *B;
3592 ConstantInt *C1, *C2;
3593 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3594 if (match(&I, m_And(m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1)),
3595 m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(B), m_ConstantInt(C2)))))
3596 if (C1 == C2 && LHSCC == RHSCC && LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
3597 C1->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3598 Instruction *NewOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, B);
3599 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOr, I);
3600 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, NewOr, C1);
3601 }
3602 }
3603
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003604 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3605 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3606 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003607 return R;
3608
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003609 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3610 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003611 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3612 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3613 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3614 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) & (X icmp C2)
3615 // ICMP_[GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[GL]T elsewhere.
3616 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3617 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3618 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattnereec8b9a2007-11-22 23:47:13 +00003619 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3620
3621 // Don't try to fold ICMP_SLT + ICMP_ULT.
3622 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) || ICmpInst::isEquality(RHSCC) ||
3623 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ==
3624 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC))) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003625 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Chris Lattneree2b7a42008-01-13 20:59:02 +00003626 ICmpInst::Predicate GT;
3627 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
3628 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
3629 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
3630 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
3631 else
3632 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3633
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003634 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3635 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003636 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003637 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3638 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3639 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3640 }
3641
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003642 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003643 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3644 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003645 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3646 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3647 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003648 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3649
3650 switch (LHSCC) {
3651 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003652 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003653 switch (RHSCC) {
3654 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003655 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3656 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3657 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003658 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003659 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3660 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3661 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003662 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3663 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003664 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003665 switch (RHSCC) {
3666 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003667 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3668 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3669 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3670 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3671 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3672 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3673 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3674 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3675 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3676 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3677 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003678 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003679 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3680 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003681 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003682 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003683 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3684 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattner424db022007-01-27 23:08:34 +00003685 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3686 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003687 }
3688 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3689 }
3690 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003691 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003692 switch (RHSCC) {
3693 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003694 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3695 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003696 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003697 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3698 break;
3699 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3700 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003701 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003702 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3703 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003704 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003705 break;
3706 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003707 switch (RHSCC) {
3708 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003709 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3710 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003711 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003712 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3713 break;
3714 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3715 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003716 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003717 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3718 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003719 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003720 break;
3721 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3722 switch (RHSCC) {
3723 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Eli Friedman5c1f1722008-06-21 23:36:13 +00003724 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003725 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3726 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3727 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3728 break;
3729 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3730 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3731 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3732 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3733 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3734 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false,
3735 true, I);
3736 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3737 break;
3738 }
3739 break;
3740 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3741 switch (RHSCC) {
3742 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattnera7d1ab02007-11-16 06:04:17 +00003743 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003744 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3745 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3746 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3747 break;
3748 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3749 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3750 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3751 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3752 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3753 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true,
3754 true, I);
3755 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3756 break;
3757 }
3758 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003759 }
3760 }
3761 }
3762
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003763 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003764 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3765 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3766 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3767 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003768 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003769 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003770 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3771 I.getType(), TD) &&
3772 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3773 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003774 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003775 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3776 I.getName());
3777 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003778 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003779 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003780 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003781
3782 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003783 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3784 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3785 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003786 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3787 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3788 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003789 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003790 SI1->getOperand(0),
3791 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003792 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003793 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003794 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003795 }
3796
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003797 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
3798 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
3799 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3800 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
3801 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD)
3802 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
3803 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
3804 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
3805 // false.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00003806 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003807 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3808 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS->getOperand(0),
3809 RHS->getOperand(0));
3810 }
3811 }
3812 }
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003813
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003814 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003815}
3816
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003817/// CollectBSwapParts - Look to see if the specified value defines a single byte
3818/// in the result. If it does, and if the specified byte hasn't been filled in
3819/// yet, fill it in and return false.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003820static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003821 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
3822 if (I == 0) return true;
3823
3824 // If this is an or instruction, it is an inner node of the bswap.
3825 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or)
3826 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3827 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), ByteValues);
3828
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003829 uint32_t BitWidth = I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003830 // If this is a shift by a constant int, and it is "24", then its operand
3831 // defines a byte. We only handle unsigned types here.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003832 if (I->isShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003833 // Not shifting the entire input by N-1 bytes?
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003834 if (cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) !=
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003835 8*(ByteValues.size()-1))
3836 return true;
3837
3838 unsigned DestNo;
3839 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
3840 // X << 24 defines the top byte with the lowest of the input bytes.
3841 DestNo = ByteValues.size()-1;
3842 } else {
3843 // X >>u 24 defines the low byte with the highest of the input bytes.
3844 DestNo = 0;
3845 }
3846
3847 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3848 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3849 if (ByteValues[DestNo] && ByteValues[DestNo] != I->getOperand(0))
3850 return true;
3851 ByteValues[DestNo] = I->getOperand(0);
3852 return false;
3853 }
3854
3855 // Otherwise, we can only handle and(shift X, imm), imm). Bail out of if we
3856 // don't have this.
3857 Value *Shift = 0, *ShiftLHS = 0;
3858 ConstantInt *AndAmt = 0, *ShiftAmt = 0;
3859 if (!match(I, m_And(m_Value(Shift), m_ConstantInt(AndAmt))) ||
3860 !match(Shift, m_Shift(m_Value(ShiftLHS), m_ConstantInt(ShiftAmt))))
3861 return true;
3862 Instruction *SI = cast<Instruction>(Shift);
3863
3864 // Make sure that the shift amount is by a multiple of 8 and isn't too big.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003865 if (ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) & 7 ||
3866 ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) > 8*ByteValues.size())
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003867 return true;
3868
3869 // Turn 0xFF -> 0, 0xFF00 -> 1, 0xFF0000 -> 2, etc.
3870 unsigned DestByte;
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003871 if (AndAmt->getValue().getActiveBits() > 64)
3872 return true;
3873 uint64_t AndAmtVal = AndAmt->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003874 for (DestByte = 0; DestByte != ByteValues.size(); ++DestByte)
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003875 if (AndAmtVal == uint64_t(0xFF) << 8*DestByte)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003876 break;
3877 // Unknown mask for bswap.
3878 if (DestByte == ByteValues.size()) return true;
3879
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003880 unsigned ShiftBytes = ShiftAmt->getZExtValue()/8;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003881 unsigned SrcByte;
3882 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
3883 SrcByte = DestByte - ShiftBytes;
3884 else
3885 SrcByte = DestByte + ShiftBytes;
3886
3887 // If the SrcByte isn't a bswapped value from the DestByte, reject it.
3888 if (SrcByte != ByteValues.size()-DestByte-1)
3889 return true;
3890
3891 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3892 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3893 if (ByteValues[DestByte] && ByteValues[DestByte] != SI->getOperand(0))
3894 return true;
3895 ByteValues[DestByte] = SI->getOperand(0);
3896 return false;
3897}
3898
3899/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
3900/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
3901Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003902 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
3903 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16)
3904 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003905
3906 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
3907 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003908 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003909 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003910
3911 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
3912 if (CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3913 CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(1), ByteValues))
3914 return 0;
3915
3916 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
3917 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
3918 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
3919
3920 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
3921 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
3922 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
3923 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00003924 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003925 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00003926 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003927 return CallInst::Create(F, V);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003928}
3929
3930
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003931Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003932 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003933 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003934
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003935 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003936 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003937
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003938 // or X, X = X
3939 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003940 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003941
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003942 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
3943 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003944 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
3945 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3946 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3947 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
3948 KnownZero, KnownOne))
3949 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003950 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3951 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
3952 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3953 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
3954 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003955 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003956
3957
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003958
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003959 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003960 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003961 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003962 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
3963 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003964 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003965 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003966 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003967 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003968 ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003969 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003970
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003971 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
3972 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003973 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003974 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003975 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003976 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003977 ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003978 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003979
3980 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3981 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003982 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003983 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003984 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3985 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3986 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003987 }
3988
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003989 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
3990 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003991
3992 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3993 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
3994 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
3995 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3996 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
3997 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3998
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003999 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
4000 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004001 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004002 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
4003 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
4004 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004005 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
4006 return BSwap;
4007 }
4008
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004009 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4010 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004011 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004012 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004013 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4014 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004015 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004016 }
4017
4018 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4019 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004020 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004021 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004022 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4023 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004024 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004025 }
4026
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004027 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00004028 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004029 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
4030 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004031 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
4032 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4033 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
4034 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
4035 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
4036 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
4037 // replace with V+N.
4038 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
4039 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
4040 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4041 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4042 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
4043 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4044 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
4045 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4046 }
4047 // Or commutes, try both ways.
4048 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
4049 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4050 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4051 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
4052 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4053 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
4054 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4055 }
4056 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00004057 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004058 }
4059
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004060 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
4061 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004062 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
4063 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
4064 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
4065 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
4066 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
4067 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
4068 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
4069 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
4070 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
4071
4072 if (V1) {
4073 Value *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004074 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
4075 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00004076 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004077 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004078 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004079
4080 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004081 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4082 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4083 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004084 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4085 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
4086 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004087 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004088 SI1->getOperand(0),
4089 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004090 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004091 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004092 }
4093 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00004094
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004095 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
4096 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004097 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004098 } else {
4099 A = 0;
4100 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004101 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004102 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
4103 if (Op0 == B)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004104 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004105
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004106 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004107 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004108 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, B,
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004109 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004110 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(And);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004111 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004112 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004113
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004114 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4115 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4116 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004117 return R;
4118
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004119 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
4120 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004121 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
4122 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
4123 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
4124 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) | (X icmp C2)
4125 // icmp [us][gl]e x, cst is folded to icmp [us][gl]t elsewhere.
4126 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4127 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4128 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004129 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
4130 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
4131 PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004132 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004133 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004134 bool NeedsSwap;
4135 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC))
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00004136 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004137 else
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00004138 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004139
4140 if (NeedsSwap) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004141 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4142 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4143 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4144 }
4145
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004146 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004147 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
4148 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004149 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
4150 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004151 // equal.
4152 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
4153
4154 switch (LHSCC) {
4155 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004156 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004157 switch (RHSCC) {
4158 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004159 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004160 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
4161 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004162 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004163 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
4164 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004165 AddCST = Subtract(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004166 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004167 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004168 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4169 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4170 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
Chris Lattner240d6f42005-04-19 06:04:18 +00004171 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004172 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4173 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4174 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004175 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4176 }
4177 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004178 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004179 switch (RHSCC) {
4180 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004181 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4182 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4183 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004184 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004185 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4186 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4187 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004188 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004189 }
4190 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004191 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004192 switch (RHSCC) {
4193 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004194 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004195 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004196 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) ->(X-13) u> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004197 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4198 // this can cause overflow.
4199 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4200 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004201 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false,
4202 false, I);
4203 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4204 break;
4205 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4206 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004207 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004208 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4209 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004210 }
4211 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004212 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004213 switch (RHSCC) {
4214 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004215 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4216 break;
4217 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) ->(X-13) s> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004218 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4219 // this can cause overflow.
4220 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4221 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004222 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true,
4223 false, I);
4224 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4225 break;
4226 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4227 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4228 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4229 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4230 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004231 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004232 break;
4233 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4234 switch (RHSCC) {
4235 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4236 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4237 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4238 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4239 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4240 break;
4241 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4242 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004243 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004244 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4245 break;
4246 }
4247 break;
4248 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4249 switch (RHSCC) {
4250 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4251 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4252 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4253 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4254 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4255 break;
4256 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4257 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004258 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004259 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4260 break;
4261 }
4262 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004263 }
4264 }
4265 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004266
4267 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004268 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004269 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004270 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004271 if (!isa<ICmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0)) ||
4272 !isa<ICmpInst>(Op1C->getOperand(0))) {
4273 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
4274 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
4275 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be
4276 // generated.
4277 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4278 I.getType(), TD) &&
4279 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4280 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004281 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004282 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4283 I.getName());
4284 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004285 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004286 }
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004287 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004288 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004289 }
4290
4291
4292 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
4293 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
4294 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4295 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Chris Lattner5ebd9362008-02-29 06:09:11 +00004296 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
4297 LHS->getOperand(0)->getType() == RHS->getOperand(0)->getType())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004298 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4299 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4300 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4301 // true.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00004302 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004303 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4304
4305 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
4306 // rest.
4307 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS->getOperand(0),
4308 RHS->getOperand(0));
4309 }
4310 }
4311 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004312
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004313 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004314}
4315
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004316namespace {
4317
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004318// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4319struct XorSelf {
4320 Value *RHS;
4321 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4322 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4323 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4324 return &Xor;
4325 }
4326};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004327
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004328}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004329
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004330Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004331 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004332 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004333
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004334 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
4335 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
4336 // Handle undef ^ undef -> 0 special case. This is a common
4337 // idiom (misuse).
4338 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004339 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004340 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004341
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004342 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
4343 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00004344 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004345 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004346 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004347
4348 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4349 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004350 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4351 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4352 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4353 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4354 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4355 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004356 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4357 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004358 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004359
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004360 // Is this a ~ operation?
4361 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
4362 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4363 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4364 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
4365 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4366 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4367 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4368 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4369 Instruction *NotY =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004370 BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004371 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4372 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4373 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004374 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004375 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004376 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004377 }
4378 }
4379 }
4380 }
4381
4382
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004383 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004384 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
4385 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
4386 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004387 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4388 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00004389
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004390 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
4391 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
4392 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
4393 }
4394
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004395 // fold (xor(zext(cmp)), 1) and (xor(sext(cmp)), -1) to ext(!cmp).
4396 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
4397 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0))) {
4398 if (CI->hasOneUse() && Op0C->hasOneUse()) {
4399 Instruction::CastOps Opcode = Op0C->getOpcode();
4400 if (Opcode == Instruction::ZExt || Opcode == Instruction::SExt) {
4401 if (RHS == ConstantExpr::getCast(Opcode, ConstantInt::getTrue(),
4402 Op0C->getDestTy())) {
4403 Instruction *NewCI = InsertNewInstBefore(CmpInst::Create(
4404 CI->getOpcode(), CI->getInversePredicate(),
4405 CI->getOperand(0), CI->getOperand(1)), I);
4406 NewCI->takeName(CI);
4407 return CastInst::Create(Opcode, NewCI, Op0C->getType());
4408 }
4409 }
4410 }
4411 }
4412 }
4413
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004414 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004415 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004416 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4417 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004418 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4419 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004420 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004421 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004422 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004423
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004424 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004425 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004426 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004427 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004428 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004429 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004430 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004431 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004432 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00004433 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004434 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
4435 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004436 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00004437
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004438 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004439 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4440 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004441 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004442 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4443 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4444 // NewRHS.
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004445 Constant *CommonBits = And(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004446 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4447 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004448 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004449 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4450 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4451 return &I;
4452 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004453 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004454 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004455 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004456
4457 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4458 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004459 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004460 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004461 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4462 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4463 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004464 }
4465
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004466 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004467 if (X == Op1)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004468 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004469
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004470 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004471 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004472 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004473
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004474
4475 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4476 if (Op1I) {
4477 Value *A, *B;
4478 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4479 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004480 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004481 I.swapOperands();
4482 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004483 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004484 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004485 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004486 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004487 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4488 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4489 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4490 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4491 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4492 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004493 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004494 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004495 std::swap(A, B);
4496 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004497 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004498 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4499 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4500 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004501 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004502 }
4503
4504 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4505 if (Op0I) {
4506 Value *A, *B;
4507 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4508 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4509 std::swap(A, B);
4510 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4511 Instruction *NotB =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004512 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4513 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004514 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004515 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4516 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4517 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4518 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4519 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4520 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4521 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4522 std::swap(A, B);
4523 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00004524 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004525 Instruction *N =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004526 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(A, "tmp"), I);
4527 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(N, Op1);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004528 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004529 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004530 }
4531
4532 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4533 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4534 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4535 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4536 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4537 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004538 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004539 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4540 Op0I->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004541 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004542 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4543 }
4544
4545 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4546 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4547 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4548 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4549 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4550 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004551 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004552 }
4553 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4554 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4555 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4556 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004557 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004558 }
4559
4560 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4561 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4562 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4563 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4564 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4565 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4566 if (A == C)
4567 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4568 else if (A == D)
4569 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4570 else if (B == C)
4571 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4572 else if (B == D)
4573 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4574
4575 if (X) {
4576 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004577 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4578 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewOp, X);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004579 }
4580 }
4581 }
4582
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004583 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4584 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4585 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004586 return R;
4587
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004588 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004589 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004590 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004591 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4592 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004593 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004594 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004595 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4596 I.getType(), TD) &&
4597 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4598 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004599 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004600 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4601 I.getName());
4602 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004603 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004604 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004605 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004606 }
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004607
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004608 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004609}
4610
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004611/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4612/// overflowed for this type.
4613static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004614 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004615 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Add(In1, In2));
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004616
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004617 if (IsSigned)
4618 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4619 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4620 else
4621 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4622 else
4623 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004624}
4625
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004626/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
4627/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
4628/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
4629static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
4630 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4631 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004632 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4633 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004634
4635 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004636 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004637 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004638
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00004639 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP->op_begin() + 1, e = GEP->op_end(); i != e;
4640 ++i, ++GTI) {
4641 Value *Op = *i;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00004642 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004643 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
4644 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
4645
4646 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4647 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4648 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
4649
4650 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
4651 Result = ConstantInt::get(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004652 else
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004653 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004654 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004655 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
4656 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4657 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004658 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004659
4660 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4661 Constant *OC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
4662 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
4663 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
4664 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
4665 else {
4666 // Emit an add instruction.
4667 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004668 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004669 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004670 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004671 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004672 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004673 // Convert to correct type.
4674 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
4675 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4676 Op = ConstantExpr::getSExt(OpC, IntPtrTy);
4677 else
4678 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new SExtInst(Op, IntPtrTy,
4679 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
4680 }
4681 if (Size != 1) {
4682 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4683 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4684 Op = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
4685 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004686 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004687 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
4688 }
4689
4690 // Emit an add instruction.
4691 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
4692 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
4693 cast<Constant>(Result));
4694 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004695 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op, Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004696 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004697 }
4698 return Result;
4699}
4700
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004701
4702/// EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression - Return an value that can be used to compare of
4703/// the *offset* implied by GEP to zero. For example, if we have &A[i], we want
4704/// to return 'i' for "icmp ne i, 0". Note that, in general, indices can be
4705/// complex, and scales are involved. The above expression would also be legal
4706/// to codegen as "icmp ne (i*4), 0" (assuming A is a pointer to i32). This
4707/// later form is less amenable to optimization though, and we are allowed to
4708/// generate the first by knowing that pointer arithmetic doesn't overflow.
4709///
4710/// If we can't emit an optimized form for this expression, this returns null.
4711///
4712static Value *EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(User *GEP, Instruction &I,
4713 InstCombiner &IC) {
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004714 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4715 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
4716
4717 // Check to see if this gep only has a single variable index. If so, and if
4718 // any constant indices are a multiple of its scale, then we can compute this
4719 // in terms of the scale of the variable index. For example, if the GEP
4720 // implies an offset of "12 + i*4", then we can codegen this as "3 + i",
4721 // because the expression will cross zero at the same point.
4722 unsigned i, e = GEP->getNumOperands();
4723 int64_t Offset = 0;
4724 for (i = 1; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4725 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
4726 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
4727 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
4728
4729 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4730 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4731 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
4732 } else {
4733 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
4734 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
4735 }
4736 } else {
4737 // Found our variable index.
4738 break;
4739 }
4740 }
4741
4742 // If there are no variable indices, we must have a constant offset, just
4743 // evaluate it the general way.
4744 if (i == e) return 0;
4745
4746 Value *VariableIdx = GEP->getOperand(i);
4747 // Determine the scale factor of the variable element. For example, this is
4748 // 4 if the variable index is into an array of i32.
4749 uint64_t VariableScale = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
4750
4751 // Verify that there are no other variable indices. If so, emit the hard way.
4752 for (++i, ++GTI; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4753 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
4754 if (!CI) return 0;
4755
4756 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
4757 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
4758
4759 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4760 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4761 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
4762 } else {
4763 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
4764 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
4765 }
4766 }
4767
4768 // Okay, we know we have a single variable index, which must be a
4769 // pointer/array/vector index. If there is no offset, life is simple, return
4770 // the index.
4771 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
4772 if (Offset == 0) {
4773 // Cast to intptrty in case a truncation occurs. If an extension is needed,
4774 // we don't need to bother extending: the extension won't affect where the
4775 // computation crosses zero.
4776 if (VariableIdx->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() > IntPtrWidth)
4777 VariableIdx = new TruncInst(VariableIdx, TD.getIntPtrType(),
4778 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
4779 return VariableIdx;
4780 }
4781
4782 // Otherwise, there is an index. The computation we will do will be modulo
4783 // the pointer size, so get it.
4784 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
4785
4786 Offset &= PtrSizeMask;
4787 VariableScale &= PtrSizeMask;
4788
4789 // To do this transformation, any constant index must be a multiple of the
4790 // variable scale factor. For example, we can evaluate "12 + 4*i" as "3 + i",
4791 // but we can't evaluate "10 + 3*i" in terms of i. Check that the offset is a
4792 // multiple of the variable scale.
4793 int64_t NewOffs = Offset / (int64_t)VariableScale;
4794 if (Offset != NewOffs*(int64_t)VariableScale)
4795 return 0;
4796
4797 // Okay, we can do this evaluation. Start by converting the index to intptr.
4798 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4799 if (VariableIdx->getType() != IntPtrTy)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004800 VariableIdx = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(VariableIdx, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004801 true /*SExt*/,
4802 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
4803 Constant *OffsetVal = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, NewOffs);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004804 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(VariableIdx, OffsetVal, "offset", &I);
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004805}
4806
4807
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004808/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004809/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004810Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
4811 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
4812 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004813 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004814
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004815 // Look through bitcasts.
4816 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(RHS))
4817 RHS = BCI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004818
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004819 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
4820 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00004821 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004822 // This transformation (ignoring the base and scales) is valid because we
4823 // know pointers can't overflow. See if we can output an optimized form.
4824 Value *Offset = EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(GEPLHS, I, *this);
4825
4826 // If not, synthesize the offset the hard way.
4827 if (Offset == 0)
4828 Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00004829 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
4830 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004831 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004832 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
4833 // compare the base pointer.
4834 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
4835 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00004836 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00004837 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004838 if (IndicesTheSame)
4839 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4840 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
4841 IndicesTheSame = false;
4842 break;
4843 }
4844
4845 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
4846 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004847 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
4848 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004849
4850 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
4851 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004852 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004853 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004854
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004855 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
4856 bool AllZeros = true;
4857 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4858 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4859 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4860 AllZeros = false;
4861 break;
4862 }
4863 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004864 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
4865 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004866
4867 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004868 AllZeros = true;
4869 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4870 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4871 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4872 AllZeros = false;
4873 break;
4874 }
4875 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004876 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004877
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004878 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
4879 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
4880 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
4881 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
4882 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4883 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00004884 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
4885 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004886 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004887 NumDifferences = 2;
4888 break;
4889 } else {
4890 if (NumDifferences++) break;
4891 DiffOperand = i;
4892 }
4893 }
4894
4895 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
4896 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00004897 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00004898 ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00004899
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004900 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004901 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
4902 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004903 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
4904 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004905 }
4906 }
4907
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004908 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004909 // the result to fold to a constant!
4910 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
4911 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
4912 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
4913 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
4914 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004915 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004916 }
4917 }
4918 return 0;
4919}
4920
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00004921/// FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst - Fold fcmp ([us]itofp x, cst) if possible.
4922///
4923Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I,
4924 Instruction *LHSI,
4925 Constant *RHSC) {
4926 if (!isa<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) return 0;
4927 const APFloat &RHS = cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)->getValueAPF();
4928
4929 // Get the width of the mantissa. We don't want to hack on conversions that
4930 // might lose information from the integer, e.g. "i64 -> float"
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00004931 int MantissaWidth = LHSI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00004932 if (MantissaWidth == -1) return 0; // Unknown.
4933
4934 // Check to see that the input is converted from an integer type that is small
4935 // enough that preserves all bits. TODO: check here for "known" sign bits.
4936 // This would allow us to handle (fptosi (x >>s 62) to float) if x is i64 f.e.
4937 unsigned InputSize = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
4938
4939 // If this is a uitofp instruction, we need an extra bit to hold the sign.
4940 if (isa<UIToFPInst>(LHSI))
4941 ++InputSize;
4942
4943 // If the conversion would lose info, don't hack on this.
4944 if ((int)InputSize > MantissaWidth)
4945 return 0;
4946
4947 // Otherwise, we can potentially simplify the comparison. We know that it
4948 // will always come through as an integer value and we know the constant is
4949 // not a NAN (it would have been previously simplified).
4950 assert(!RHS.isNaN() && "NaN comparison not already folded!");
4951
4952 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
4953 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4954 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected predicate!");
4955 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ:
4956 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ; break;
4957 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
4958 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT; break;
4959 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
4960 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE; break;
4961 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
4962 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT; break;
4963 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
4964 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE; break;
4965 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE:
4966 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_NE; break;
4967 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD:
4968 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4969 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO:
4970 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4971 }
4972
4973 const IntegerType *IntTy = cast<IntegerType>(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType());
4974
4975 // Now we know that the APFloat is a normal number, zero or inf.
4976
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00004977 // See if the FP constant is too large for the integer. For example,
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00004978 // comparing an i8 to 300.0.
4979 unsigned IntWidth = IntTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
4980
4981 // If the RHS value is > SignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles +INF
4982 // and large values.
4983 APFloat SMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
4984 SMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(IntWidth), true,
4985 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
4986 if (SMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // smax < 13123.0
Chris Lattner393f7eb2008-05-24 04:06:28 +00004987 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT ||
4988 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00004989 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4990 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4991 }
4992
4993 // See if the RHS value is < SignedMin.
4994 APFloat SMin(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
4995 SMin.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMinValue(IntWidth), true,
4996 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
4997 if (SMin.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpGreaterThan) { // smin > 12312.0
Chris Lattner393f7eb2008-05-24 04:06:28 +00004998 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT ||
4999 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005000 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5001 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5002 }
5003
5004 // Okay, now we know that the FP constant fits in the range [SMIN, SMAX] but
5005 // it may still be fractional. See if it is fractional by casting the FP
5006 // value to the integer value and back, checking for equality. Don't do this
5007 // for zero, because -0.0 is not fractional.
5008 Constant *RHSInt = ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(RHSC, IntTy);
5009 if (!RHS.isZero() &&
5010 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) != RHSC) {
5011 // If we had a comparison against a fractional value, we have to adjust
5012 // the compare predicate and sometimes the value. RHSC is rounded towards
5013 // zero at this point.
5014 switch (Pred) {
5015 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected integer comparison!");
5016 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (float)int != 4.4 --> true
5017 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5018 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (float)int == 4.4 --> false
5019 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5020 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5021 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5022 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> int < -4
5023 if (RHS.isNegative())
5024 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5025 break;
5026 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5027 // (float)int < -4.4 --> int < -4
5028 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5029 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5030 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5031 break;
5032 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5033 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5034 // (float)int > -4.4 --> int >= -4
5035 if (RHS.isNegative())
5036 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5037 break;
5038 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5039 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> int >= -4
5040 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5041 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5042 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5043 break;
5044 }
5045 }
5046
5047 // Lower this FP comparison into an appropriate integer version of the
5048 // comparison.
5049 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0), RHSInt);
5050}
5051
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005052Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
5053 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005054 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005055
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005056 // Fold trivial predicates.
5057 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
5058 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
5059 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
5060 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5061
5062 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
5063 if (Op0 == Op1) {
5064 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5065 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
5066 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
5067 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
5068 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
5069 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5070 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
5071 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
5072 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
5073 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5074
5075 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
5076 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
5077 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
5078 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
5079 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
5080 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
5081 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5082 return &I;
5083
5084 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
5085 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
5086 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
5087 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
5088 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
5089 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
5090 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5091 return &I;
5092 }
5093 }
5094
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005095 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005096 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005097
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005098 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
5099 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005100 // If the constant is a nan, see if we can fold the comparison based on it.
5101 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
5102 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isNaN()) {
5103 if (FCmpInst::isOrdered(I.getPredicate())) // True if ordered and...
5104 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005105 assert(FCmpInst::isUnordered(I.getPredicate()) &&
5106 "Comparison must be either ordered or unordered!");
5107 // True if unordered.
5108 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005109 }
5110 }
5111
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005112 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5113 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
5114 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005115 // Only fold fcmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5116 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5117 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5118 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5119 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5120 return NV;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005121 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005122 case Instruction::SIToFP:
5123 case Instruction::UIToFP:
5124 if (Instruction *NV = FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(I, LHSI, RHSC))
5125 return NV;
5126 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005127 case Instruction::Select:
5128 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5129 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5130 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5131 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5132 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5133 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5134 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5135 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5136 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5137 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5138 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5139 I.getName()), I);
5140 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5141 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5142 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5143 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5144 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5145 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5146 I.getName()), I);
5147 }
5148 }
5149
5150 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005151 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005152 break;
5153 }
5154 }
5155
5156 return Changed ? &I : 0;
5157}
5158
5159Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
5160 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
5161 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
5162 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
5163
5164 // icmp X, X
5165 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005166 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005167 I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005168
5169 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005170 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Christopher Lamb7a0678c2007-12-18 21:32:20 +00005171
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005172 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005173 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005174 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
5175 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
5176 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005177 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005178 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005179 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005180
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005181 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005182 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005183 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5184 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005185 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq i1 A, B -> ~(A^B)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005186 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005187 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005188 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005189 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005190 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq i1 A, B -> A^B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005191 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005192
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005193 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005194 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ugt -> icmp ult
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005195 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005196 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:{ // icmp ult i1 A, B -> ~A & B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005197 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005198 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005199 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005200 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005201 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5202 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sgt -> icmp slt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005203 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005204 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp slt i1 A, B -> A & ~B
5205 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5206 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5207 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op0);
5208 }
5209 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5210 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp uge -> icmp ule
5211 // FALL THROUGH
5212 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: { // icmp ule i1 A, B -> ~A | B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005213 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005214 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005215 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005216 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005217 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5218 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sge -> icmp sle
5219 // FALL THROUGH
5220 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp sle i1 A, B -> A | ~B
5221 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5222 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5223 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op0);
5224 }
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005225 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005226 }
5227
Chris Lattner2be51ae2004-06-09 04:24:29 +00005228 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
5229 // can be folded into the comparison.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005230 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00005231 Value *A, *B;
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005232
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00005233 // (icmp ne/eq (sub A B) 0) -> (icmp ne/eq A, B)
5234 if (I.isEquality() && CI->isNullValue() &&
5235 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5236 // (icmp cond A B) if cond is equality
5237 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Owen Andersonf5783f82007-12-28 07:42:12 +00005238 }
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005239
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005240 // If we have a icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the appropriate
5241 // icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. This allows us to rely on them being
5242 // folded in the code below.
5243 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5244 default: break;
5245 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5246 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
5247 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5248 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5249 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5250 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
5251 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5252 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5253 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5254 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
5255 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5256 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5257 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5258 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
5259 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5260 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5261 }
5262
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005263 // See if we can fold the comparison based on range information we can get
5264 // by checking whether bits are known to be zero or one in the input.
5265 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
5266 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
5267
5268 // If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005269 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005270 bool UnusedBit;
5271 bool isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
5272
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005273 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0,
5274 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
5275 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005276 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
5277 return &I;
5278
5279 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005280 // in. Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
5281 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
5282 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005283 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate()))
5284 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min, Max);
5285 else
5286 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne,Min,Max);
5287
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005288 // If Min and Max are known to be the same, then SimplifyDemandedBits
5289 // figured out that the LHS is a constant. Just constant fold this now so
5290 // that code below can assume that Min != Max.
5291 if (Min == Max)
5292 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(),
5293 ConstantInt::get(Min),
5294 CI));
5295
5296 // Based on the range information we know about the LHS, see if we can
5297 // simplify this comparison. For example, (x&4) < 8 is always true.
5298 const APInt &RHSVal = CI->getValue();
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005299 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
5300 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
5301 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5302 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5303 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5304 break;
5305 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5306 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5307 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5308 break;
5309 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005310 if (Max.ult(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005311 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005312 if (Min.uge(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005313 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005314 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
5315 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5316 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
5317 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5318
5319 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
5320 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
5321 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
5322 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005323 break;
5324 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005325 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005326 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005327 if (Max.ule(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005328 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005329
5330 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
5331 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5332 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5333 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5334
5335 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
5336 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
5337 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
5338 ConstantInt::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005339 break;
5340 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005341 if (Max.slt(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005342 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerd01bee72008-07-11 06:40:29 +00005343 if (Min.sge(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005344 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005345 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
5346 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera8ff4a82008-07-11 06:36:01 +00005347 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
Chris Lattnerf9685ac2008-07-11 06:38:16 +00005348 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005349 break;
5350 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005351 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005352 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005353 if (Max.sle(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005354 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005355
5356 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
5357 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5358 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5359 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005360 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005361 }
5362
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005363 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00005364 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005365 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00005366 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005367 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
5368 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005369 }
5370
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005371 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005372 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
5373 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5374 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005375 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
5376 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005377 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005378 bool isAllZeros = true;
5379 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5380 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
5381 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5382 isAllZeros = false;
5383 break;
5384 }
5385 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005386 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005387 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
5388 }
5389 break;
5390
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005391 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005392 // Only fold icmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5393 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5394 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5395 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5396 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5397 return NV;
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005398 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005399 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005400 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5401 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5402 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5403 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5404 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5405 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5406 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005407 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5408 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5409 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5410 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5411 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005412 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5413 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005414 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5415 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5416 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5417 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5418 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005419 }
5420 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00005421
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005422 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005423 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005424 break;
5425 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005426 case Instruction::Malloc:
5427 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
5428 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
5429 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
5430 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5431 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005432 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005433 }
5434 break;
5435 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005436 }
5437
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005438 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005439 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005440 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005441 return NI;
5442 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005443 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
5444 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005445 return NI;
5446
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005447 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005448 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
5449 // now.
5450 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
5451 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
5452 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005453 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
5454 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005455 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005456
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005457 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
5458 // so eliminate it as well.
5459 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
5460 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005461
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005462 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005463 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType()) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005464 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00005465 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005466 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005467 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00005468 Op1 = InsertBitCastBefore(Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005469 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005470 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005471 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005472 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005473 }
5474
5475 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005476 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005477 // This comes up when you have code like
5478 // int X = A < B;
5479 // if (X) ...
5480 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005481 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5482 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005483 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005484 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005485 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005486
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005487 // See if it's the same type of instruction on the left and right.
5488 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5489 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
5490 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
5491 Op1I->hasOneUse() && Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
5492 I.isEquality()) {
5493 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
5494 default: break;
5495 case Instruction::Add:
5496 case Instruction::Sub:
5497 case Instruction::Xor:
5498 // a+x icmp eq/ne b+x --> a icmp b
5499 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0I->getOperand(0),
5500 Op1I->getOperand(0));
5501 break;
5502 case Instruction::Mul:
5503 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewycky1f26c182008-07-11 07:36:19 +00005504 // a * Cst icmp eq/ne b * Cst --> a & Mask icmp b & Mask
Nick Lewycky7d9843f2008-07-11 08:16:26 +00005505 // Mask = -1 >> count-trailing-zeros(Cst).
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005506 if (!CI->isZero() && !CI->isOne()) {
5507 const APInt &AP = CI->getValue();
5508 ConstantInt *Mask = ConstantInt::get(
5509 APInt::getLowBitsSet(AP.getBitWidth(),
5510 AP.getBitWidth() -
5511 AP.countTrailingZeros()));
5512 Instruction *And1 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0I->getOperand(0),
5513 Mask);
5514 Instruction *And2 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1I->getOperand(0),
5515 Mask);
5516 InsertNewInstBefore(And1, I);
5517 InsertNewInstBefore(And2, I);
5518 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And1, And2);
5519 }
5520 }
5521 break;
5522 }
5523 }
5524 }
5525 }
5526
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005527 // ~x < ~y --> y < x
5528 { Value *A, *B;
5529 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A))) &&
5530 match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B))))
5531 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, A);
5532 }
5533
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005534 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005535 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005536
5537 // -x == -y --> x == y
5538 if (match(Op0, m_Neg(m_Value(A))) &&
5539 match(Op1, m_Neg(m_Value(B))))
5540 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
5541
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005542 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5543 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
5544 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
5545 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5546 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
5547 }
5548
5549 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5550 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
5551 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
5552 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
5553 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00005554 Constant *NC = ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005555 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, NC, "tmp");
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005556 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
5557 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
5558 }
5559
5560 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
5561 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
5562 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
5563 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
5564 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
5565 }
5566 }
5567
5568 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5569 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005570 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
5571 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005572 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5573 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005574 }
5575 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005576 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005577 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5578 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005579 }
5580 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005581 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005582 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5583 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005584 }
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005585
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005586 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
5587 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
5588 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5589 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5590 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5591
5592 if (A == C) {
5593 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
5594 } else if (A == D) {
5595 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
5596 } else if (B == C) {
5597 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
5598 } else if (B == D) {
5599 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
5600 }
5601
5602 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005603 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
5604 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005605 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
5606 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
5607 return &I;
5608 }
5609 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005610 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005611 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005612}
5613
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005614
5615/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
5616/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
5617Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
5618 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
5619 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5620 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
5621
5622 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
5623 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
5624 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
5625 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
5626 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
5627 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
5628 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
5629 // if it finds it.
5630 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
5631 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
5632 return 0;
5633 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005634 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005635
5636 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
5637 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
5638 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
5639 // instead of computing a divide.
5640 ConstantInt *Prod = Multiply(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
5641
5642 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
5643 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
5644 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
5645 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
5646 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
5647
5648 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005649 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005650
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005651 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
5652 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
5653 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
5654 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
5655 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
5656 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
5657 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
5658 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
5659 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
5660
5661
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005662 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005663 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005664 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005665 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5666 if (!HiOverflow)
5667 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005668 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005669 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005670 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005671 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
5672 HiBound = DivRHS;
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005673 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005674 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
5675 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5676 if (!HiOverflow)
5677 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005678 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005679 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005680 Constant *DivRHSH = ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS));
5681 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod,
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005682 cast<ConstantInt>(DivRHSH), true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005683 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005684 HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005685 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005686 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isNegative()) { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005687 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005688 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005689 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
5690 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005691 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
5692 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
5693 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
5694 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005695 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005696 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
5697 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005698 if (!LoOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005699 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod, AddOne(DivRHS), true) ?-1:0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005700 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
5701 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005702 // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005703 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005704 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? 1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005705 HiBound = Subtract(Prod, DivRHS);
5706 }
5707
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005708 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
5709 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005710 }
5711
5712 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005713 switch (Pred) {
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005714 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
5715 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5716 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5717 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5718 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005719 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005720 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
5721 else if (LoOverflow)
5722 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
5723 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
5724 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005725 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005726 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5727 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5728 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5729 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005730 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005731 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
5732 else if (LoOverflow)
5733 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
5734 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5735 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005736 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005737 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5738 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005739 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
5740 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5741 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005742 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005743 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005744 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5745 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005746 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005747 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005748 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
5749 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5750 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005751 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5752 else
5753 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
5754 }
5755}
5756
5757
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005758/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
5759///
5760Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
5761 Instruction *LHSI,
5762 ConstantInt *RHS) {
5763 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
5764
5765 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00005766 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005767 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5768 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
5769 // fold the xor.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005770 if ((ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0) ||
5771 (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005772 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
5773
5774 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
5775 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
5776 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
5777 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
5778 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5779 return &ICI;
5780 }
5781
5782 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
5783 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5784
5785 // If so, the new one isn't.
5786 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
5787
5788 if (isTrueIfPositive)
5789 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal, SubOne(RHS));
5790 else
5791 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal, AddOne(RHS));
5792 }
5793 }
5794 break;
5795 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
5796 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
5797 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
5798 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5799
5800 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
5801 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
5802 // produced, eliminating a cast.
5803 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
5804 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
5805 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
5806 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
5807 // bit would not work.
5808 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
Anton Korobeynikov4aefd6b2008-02-20 12:07:57 +00005809 (ICI.isEquality() ||
5810 (AndCST->getValue().isNonNegative() && RHSV.isNonNegative()))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005811 uint32_t BitWidth =
5812 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
5813 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
5814 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
5815 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
5816 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
5817 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005818 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005819 ConstantInt::get(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
5820 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5821 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
5822 ConstantInt::get(NewCI));
5823 }
5824 }
5825
5826 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
5827 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
5828 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
5829 // access.
5830 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
5831 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
5832 Shift = 0;
5833
5834 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
5835 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
5836 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
5837 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
5838
5839 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
5840 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
5841 // rights, as they sign-extend.
5842 if (ShAmt) {
5843 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
5844 if (!CanFold) {
5845 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
5846 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
5847 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5848 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
5849
5850 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5851 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
5852 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
5853 CanFold = true;
5854 }
5855
5856 if (CanFold) {
5857 Constant *NewCst;
5858 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5859 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
5860 else
5861 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
5862
5863 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
5864 // compared.
5865 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
5866 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
5867 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
5868 // result is always true or false now.
5869 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
5870 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5871 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
5872 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5873 } else {
5874 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
5875 Constant *NewAndCST;
5876 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5877 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
5878 else
5879 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
5880 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
5881 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
5882 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
5883 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
5884 return &ICI;
5885 }
5886 }
5887 }
5888
5889 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
5890 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
5891 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
5892 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
5893 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
5894 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
5895 // Compute C << Y.
5896 Value *NS;
5897 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005898 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005899 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5900 } else {
5901 // Insert a logical shift.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005902 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005903 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5904 }
5905 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
5906
5907 // Compute X & (C << Y).
5908 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005909 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005910 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5911
5912 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
5913 return &ICI;
5914 }
5915 }
5916 break;
5917
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005918 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
5919 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5920 if (!ShAmt) break;
5921
5922 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5923
5924 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5925 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5926 // simplified.
5927 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5928 break;
5929
5930 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5931 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5932 // comparison cannot succeed.
5933 Constant *Comp =
5934 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt), ShAmt);
5935 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
5936 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5937 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
5938 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
5939 }
5940
5941 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5942 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
5943 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
5944 Constant *Mask =
5945 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005946
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005947 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005948 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005949 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5950 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5951 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
5952 ConstantInt::get(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005953 }
5954 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005955
5956 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
5957 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
5958 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
5959 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
5960 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
5961 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
5962 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
5963 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005964 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005965 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5966 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5967
5968 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
5969 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
5970 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005971 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005972 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005973
5974 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005975 case Instruction::AShr: {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005976 // Only handle equality comparisons of shift-by-constant.
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005977 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005978 if (!ShAmt || !ICI.isEquality()) break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005979
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005980 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5981 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5982 // simplified.
5983 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5984 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5985 break;
5986
5987 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005988
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005989 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5990 // comparison cannot succeed.
5991 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
5992 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
5993 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
5994 else
5995 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
5996
5997 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
5998 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5999 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6000 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6001 }
6002
6003 // Otherwise, check to see if the bits shifted out are known to be zero.
6004 // If so, we can compare against the unshifted value:
6005 // (X & 4) >> 1 == 2 --> (X & 4) == 4.
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006006 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6007 MaskedValueIsZero(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006008 APInt::getLowBitsSet(Comp.getBitWidth(), ShAmtVal))) {
6009 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
6010 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
6011 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006012
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006013 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006014 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6015 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
6016 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006017
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006018 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006019 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006020 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6021 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6022 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6023 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006024 }
6025 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006026 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006027
6028 case Instruction::SDiv:
6029 case Instruction::UDiv:
6030 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
6031 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
6032 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
6033 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
6034 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
6035 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006036 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
6037 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
6038 DivRHS))
6039 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006040 break;
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006041
6042 case Instruction::Add:
6043 // Fold: icmp pred (add, X, C1), C2
6044
6045 if (!ICI.isEquality()) {
6046 ConstantInt *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6047 if (!LHSC) break;
6048 const APInt &LHSV = LHSC->getValue();
6049
6050 ConstantRange CR = ICI.makeConstantRange(ICI.getPredicate(), RHSV)
6051 .subtract(LHSV);
6052
6053 if (ICI.isSignedPredicate()) {
6054 if (CR.getLower().isSignBit()) {
6055 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6056 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6057 } else if (CR.getUpper().isSignBit()) {
6058 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6059 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6060 }
6061 } else {
6062 if (CR.getLower().isMinValue()) {
6063 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6064 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6065 } else if (CR.getUpper().isMinValue()) {
6066 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6067 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6068 }
6069 }
6070 }
6071 break;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006072 }
6073
6074 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
6075 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6076 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6077
6078 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
6079 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
6080 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
6081 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
6082 case Instruction::SRem:
6083 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
6084 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
6085 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
6086 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
6087 Instruction *NewRem =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006088 BinaryOperator::CreateURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006089 BO->getName());
6090 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
6091 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
6092 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
6093 }
6094 }
6095 break;
6096 case Instruction::Add:
6097 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
6098 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6099 if (BO->hasOneUse())
6100 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6101 Subtract(RHS, BOp1C));
6102 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
6103 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
6104 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
6105 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
6106
6107 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
6108 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
6109 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
6110 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
6111 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006112 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006113 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
6114 Neg->takeName(BO);
6115 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
6116 }
6117 }
6118 break;
6119 case Instruction::Xor:
6120 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
6121 // the explicit xor.
6122 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
6123 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6124 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
6125
6126 // FALLTHROUGH
6127 case Instruction::Sub:
6128 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
6129 if (RHSV == 0)
6130 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6131 BO->getOperand(1));
6132 break;
6133
6134 case Instruction::Or:
6135 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
6136 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
6137 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6138 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
6139 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
6140 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6141 isICMP_NE));
6142 }
6143 break;
6144
6145 case Instruction::And:
6146 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6147 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
6148 // comparison can never succeed!
6149 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
6150 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6151 isICMP_NE));
6152
6153 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
6154 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
6155 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
6156 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
6157 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
6158
6159 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00006160 if (BOC->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006161 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6162 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
6163 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6164 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
6165 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
6166 }
6167
6168 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
6169 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
6170 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6171 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
6172 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6173 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
6174 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
6175 }
6176 }
6177 default: break;
6178 }
6179 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
6180 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
6181 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
6182 AddToWorkList(II);
6183 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
6184 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(RHSV.byteSwap()));
6185 return &ICI;
6186 }
6187 }
6188 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006189 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size,
6190 // then since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006191 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI)) {
6192 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
6193 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
6194 uint32_t SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6195 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
6196 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
6197 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
6198 // smaller constant values.
6199 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT && RHSV.isSignBit()) {
6200 // X u< 128 => X s> -1
6201 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
6202 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
6203 } else if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT &&
6204 RHSV == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize)) {
6205 // X u> 127 => X s< 0
6206 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
6207 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
6208 }
6209 }
6210 }
6211 }
6212 return 0;
6213}
6214
6215/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
6216/// We only handle extending casts so far.
6217///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006218Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
6219 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006220 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
6221 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006222 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006223 Value *RHSCIOp;
6224
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006225 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
6226 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
6227 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
6228 getTargetData().getPointerSizeInBits() ==
6229 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
6230 Value *RHSOp = 0;
6231 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6f6f5122007-05-06 07:24:03 +00006232 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006233 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
6234 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
6235 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
6236 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00006237 RHSOp = InsertBitCastBefore(RHSOp, LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006238 }
6239
6240 if (RHSOp)
6241 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
6242 }
6243
6244 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
6245 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006246 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
6247 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00006248 return 0;
6249
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006250 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
6251 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006252
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006253 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006254 // Not an extension from the same type?
6255 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006256 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
6257 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006258
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006259 // If the signedness of the two casts doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006260 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
6261 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
6262 return 0;
6263
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006264 // Deal with equality cases early.
6265 if (ICI.isEquality())
6266 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6267
6268 // A signed comparison of sign extended values simplifies into a
6269 // signed comparison.
6270 if (isSignedCmp && isSignedExt)
6271 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6272
6273 // The other three cases all fold into an unsigned comparison.
6274 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getUnsignedPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00006275 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006276
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006277 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
6278 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6279 if (!CI)
6280 return 0;
6281
6282 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
6283 // reextended to DestTy.
6284 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
6285 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
6286
6287 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
6288 if (Res2 == CI) {
6289 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
6290 // For example, we might have:
6291 // %A = sext short %X to uint
6292 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
6293 // It is incorrect to transform this into
6294 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
6295 // because %A may have negative value.
6296 //
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006297 // However, we allow this when the compare is EQ/NE, because they are
6298 // signless.
6299 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006300 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006301 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006302 }
6303
6304 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
6305 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
6306
6307 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
6308 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
6309 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006310 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006311 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006312 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006313
6314 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
6315 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
6316 Value *Result;
6317 if (isSignedCmp) {
6318 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00006319 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006320 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006321 else
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006322 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006323 } else {
6324 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
6325 if (isSignedExt) {
6326 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
6327 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006328 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006329 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
6330 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
6331 } else {
6332 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006333 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006334 }
6335 }
6336
6337 // Finally, return the value computed.
6338 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006339 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006340 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006341
6342 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
6343 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
6344 "ICmp should be folded!");
6345 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
6346 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
6347 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Result);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006348}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006349
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006350Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
6351 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6352}
6353
6354Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
6355 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6356}
6357
6358Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006359 if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
6360 return R;
6361
6362 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
6363
6364 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
6365 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
6366 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
6367 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
6368
6369 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
Nate Begeman5bc1ea02008-07-29 15:49:41 +00006370 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType()) &&
6371 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006372 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006373 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006374
6375 return 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006376}
6377
6378Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
6379 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006380 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006381
6382 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
6383 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006384 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00006385 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
6386 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006387
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006388 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
6389 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00006390 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006391 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006392 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
6393 }
6394 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006395 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
6396 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
6397 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006398 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006399 }
6400
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006401 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6402 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
6403 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006404 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006405 return R;
6406
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006407 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006408 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
6409 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006410 return 0;
6411}
6412
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006413Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006414 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006415 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006416
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006417 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
6418 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006419 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6420 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
6421 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006422 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6423 return &I;
6424
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006425 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
6426 // of a signed value.
6427 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006428 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006429 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006430 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
6431 else {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006432 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006433 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00006434 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006435 }
6436
6437 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
6438 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
6439 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
6440 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006441 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006442 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
6443
6444 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6445 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
6446 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
6447 return R;
6448 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
6449 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
6450 return NV;
6451
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006452 // Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
6453 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
6454 Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
6455 // If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
6456 // place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
6457 // require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
6458 // confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
6459 // xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
6460 if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
6461 isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
6462 // Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
6463 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006464 Instruction *NSh = BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006465 I.getName());
6466 InsertNewInstBefore(NSh, I); // (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
6467
6468 // For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
6469 // part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
6470 // clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
6471 // other xforms later if dead.
6472 unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6473 unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6474 APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
6475
6476 // The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
6477 // between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
6478 // shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
6479 // mask as appropriate.
6480 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6481 MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
6482 else {
6483 assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
6484 MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
6485 }
6486
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006487 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NSh, ConstantInt::get(MaskV),
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006488 TI->getName());
6489 InsertNewInstBefore(And, I); // shift1 & 0x00FF
6490
6491 // Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
6492 return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
6493 }
6494 }
6495
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006496 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006497 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
6498 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
6499 Value *V1, *V2;
6500 ConstantInt *CC;
6501 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006502 default: break;
6503 case Instruction::Add:
6504 case Instruction::And:
6505 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006506 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006507 // These operators commute.
6508 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006509 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
6510 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006511 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006512 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006513 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006514 Op0BO->getName());
6515 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006516 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006517 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006518 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006519 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006520 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006521 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006522 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006523 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006524
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006525 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006526 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006527 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006528 match(Op0BOOp1,
6529 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006530 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6531 V2 == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006532 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006533 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
6534 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006535 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6536 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006537 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006538 V1->getName()+".mask");
6539 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6540
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006541 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006542 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006543 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006544
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006545 // FALL THROUGH.
6546 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006547 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006548 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6549 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006550 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006551 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006552 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6553 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006554 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006555 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006556 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006557 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006558 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006559 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006560 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006561 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006562 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006563
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00006564 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006565 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6566 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
6567 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006568 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006569 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
6570 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006571 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006572 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6573 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006574 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6575 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006576 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006577 V1->getName()+".mask");
6578 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6579
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006580 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006581 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006582
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006583 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006584 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006585 }
6586
6587
6588 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
6589 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
6590 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
6591 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
6592 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
6593
6594 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006595 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00006596 case Instruction::Add:
6597 isValid = isLeftShift;
6598 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006599 case Instruction::Or:
6600 case Instruction::Xor:
6601 highBitSet = false;
6602 break;
6603 case Instruction::And:
6604 highBitSet = true;
6605 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006606 }
6607
6608 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
6609 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
6610 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
6611 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
6612 // operation.
6613 //
Chris Lattnerc95ba442007-12-06 06:25:04 +00006614 if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006615 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006616
6617 if (isValid) {
6618 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
6619
6620 Instruction *NewShift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006621 BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006622 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006623 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006624
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006625 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006626 NewRHS);
6627 }
6628 }
6629 }
6630 }
6631
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006632 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006633 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
6634 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
6635 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006636
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006637 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006638 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006639 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6640 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006641 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
6642 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
6643 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006644
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006645 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006646 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
6647 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006648
6649 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
6650
6651 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00006652 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006653 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006654 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6655 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
6656 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
6657 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006658 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006659 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
6660 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6661 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
6662 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006663 BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006664 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6665
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006666 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006667 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006668 }
6669
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006670 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
6671 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
6672 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
6673 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
6674 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006675 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006676 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006677 }
6678 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
6679 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00006680 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006681 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006682 }
6683 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
6684 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
6685 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
6686 // generators.
6687 const Type *SExtType = 0;
6688 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006689 case 1 :
6690 case 8 :
6691 case 16 :
6692 case 32 :
6693 case 64 :
6694 case 128:
6695 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
6696 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006697 default: break;
6698 }
6699 if (SExtType) {
6700 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
6701 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
6702 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
6703 }
6704 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
6705 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006706 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006707
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006708 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006709 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6710 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6711 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006712 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006713 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006714 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6715
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006716 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006717 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006718 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006719
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006720 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006721 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6722 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6723 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006724 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006725 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006726
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00006727 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006728 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006729 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006730
6731 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
6732 } else {
6733 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006734 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006735
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006736 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006737 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6738 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6739 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
6740 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006741 BinaryOperator::Create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006742 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6743 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6744
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006745 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006746 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006747 }
6748
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006749 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006750 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6751 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6752 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006753 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006754 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6755
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00006756 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006757 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006758 }
6759
6760 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006761 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006762 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006763 return 0;
6764}
6765
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00006766
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006767/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
6768/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
6769/// X*Scale+Offset.
6770///
6771static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006772 int &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006773 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006774 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006775 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00006776 Scale = 0;
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006777 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00006778 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
6779 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
6780 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6781 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
6782 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
6783 Offset = 0;
6784 return I->getOperand(0);
6785 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
6786 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
6787 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
6788 Offset = 0;
6789 return I->getOperand(0);
6790 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
6791 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
6792 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
6793 unsigned SubScale;
6794 Value *SubVal =
6795 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
6796 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
6797 Scale = SubScale;
6798 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006799 }
6800 }
6801 }
6802
6803 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
6804 Scale = 1;
6805 Offset = 0;
6806 return Val;
6807}
6808
6809
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006810/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
6811/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006812Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006813 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006814 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006815
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006816 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
6817 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00006818
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006819 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
6820 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
6821 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
6822 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
6823 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
6824
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006825 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00006826 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00006827 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006828 }
6829 }
6830
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006831 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
6832 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
6833 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
6834 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006835
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00006836 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
6837 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006838 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6839
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006840 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
6841 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
6842 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
6843 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6844
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00006845 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(AllocElTy);
6846 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006847 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006848
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006849 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
6850 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006851 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
6852 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006853 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
6854 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
6855
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006856 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
6857 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006858 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
6859 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006860
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006861 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
6862 Value *Amt = 0;
6863 if (Scale == 1) {
6864 Amt = NumElements;
6865 } else {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006866 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006867 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
6868 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00006869 Amt = Multiply(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006870 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006871 else if (Scale != 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006872 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006873 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006874 }
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006875 }
6876
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006877 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
6878 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006879 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006880 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
6881 }
6882
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006883 AllocationInst *New;
6884 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006885 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006886 else
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006887 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006888 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006889 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006890
6891 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
6892 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
6893 // die soon.
6894 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
6895 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006896 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
6897 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
6898 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006899 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
6900 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
6901 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006902 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
6903}
6904
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006905/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006906/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
6907/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
6908/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
6909/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
6910///
6911/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
6912/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00006913///
6914/// If CastOpc is a truncation, then Ty will be a type smaller than V. We
6915/// should return true if trunc(V) can be computed by computing V in the smaller
6916/// type. If V is an instruction, then trunc(inst(x,y)) can be computed as
6917/// inst(trunc(x),trunc(y)), which only makes sense if x and y can be
6918/// efficiently truncated.
6919///
6920/// If CastOpc is a sext or zext, we are asking if the low bits of the value can
6921/// bit computed in a larger type, which is then and'd or sext_in_reg'd to get
6922/// the final result.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00006923bool InstCombiner::CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
6924 unsigned CastOpc,
6925 int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006926 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
6927 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
6928 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006929
6930 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006931 if (!I) return false;
6932
6933 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006934
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006935 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
6936 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
6937 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
6938 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
6939 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
6940 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
6941 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
6942 // casts first.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00006943 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)) && I->hasOneUse())
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006944 ++NumCastsRemoved;
6945 return true;
6946 }
6947 }
6948
6949 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
6950 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
6951 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
6952
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006953 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006954 case Instruction::Add:
6955 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00006956 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006957 case Instruction::And:
6958 case Instruction::Or:
6959 case Instruction::Xor:
6960 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006961 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6962 NumCastsRemoved) &&
6963 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
6964 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006965
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006966 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006967 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
6968 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
6969 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006970 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6971 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
6972 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006973 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6974 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006975 }
6976 break;
6977 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006978 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
6979 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
6980 // already zeros.
6981 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006982 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
6983 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6984 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006985 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006986 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
6987 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006988 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6989 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006990 }
6991 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006992 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006993 case Instruction::ZExt:
6994 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006995 case Instruction::Trunc:
6996 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00006997 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
6998 // of casts in the input.
6999 if (I->getOpcode() == CastOpc)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007000 return true;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007001 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007002 case Instruction::Select: {
7003 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I);
7004 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getTrueValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7005 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7006 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getFalseValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7007 NumCastsRemoved);
7008 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007009 case Instruction::PHI: {
7010 // We can change a phi if we can change all operands.
7011 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7012 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
7013 if (!CanEvaluateInDifferentType(PN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, CastOpc,
7014 NumCastsRemoved))
7015 return false;
7016 return true;
7017 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007018 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007019 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7020 break;
7021 }
7022
7023 return false;
7024}
7025
7026/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
7027/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
7028/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007029Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007030 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007031 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007032 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007033
7034 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
7035 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00007036 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007037 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007038 case Instruction::Add:
7039 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00007040 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007041 case Instruction::And:
7042 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007043 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007044 case Instruction::AShr:
7045 case Instruction::LShr:
7046 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007047 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007048 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007049 Res = BinaryOperator::Create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007050 LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007051 break;
7052 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007053 case Instruction::Trunc:
7054 case Instruction::ZExt:
7055 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007056 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007057 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
7058 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007059 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
7060 return I->getOperand(0);
7061
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007062 // Otherwise, must be the same type of cast, so just reinsert a new one.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007063 Res = CastInst::Create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007064 Ty);
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007065 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007066 case Instruction::Select: {
7067 Value *True = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
7068 Value *False = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(2), Ty, isSigned);
7069 Res = SelectInst::Create(I->getOperand(0), True, False);
7070 break;
7071 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007072 case Instruction::PHI: {
7073 PHINode *OPN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7074 PHINode *NPN = PHINode::Create(Ty);
7075 for (unsigned i = 0, e = OPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7076 Value *V =EvaluateInDifferentType(OPN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, isSigned);
7077 NPN->addIncoming(V, OPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
7078 }
7079 Res = NPN;
7080 break;
7081 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007082 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007083 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7084 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
7085 break;
7086 }
7087
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007088 Res->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007089 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
7090}
7091
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007092/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
7093Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00007094 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7095
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00007096 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007097 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007098 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007099 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
7100 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
7101 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
7102 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007103 return CastInst::Create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00007104 }
7105 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00007106
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007107 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007108 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
7109 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
7110 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007111
7112 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007113 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
7114 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
7115 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007116
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007117 return 0;
7118}
7119
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007120/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
7121Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7122 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7123
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007124 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007125 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
7126 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007127 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
7128 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
7129 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
7130 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007131 AddToWorkList(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007132 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
7133 return &CI;
7134 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007135
7136 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
7137 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
7138 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
7139 // non-type-safe code.
7140 if (GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
7141 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
7142 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
7143 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
7144 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
7145
7146 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
7147 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
7148 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
7149 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
7150 if (GEPIdxTy->isSized()) {
7151 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
7152
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007153 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
7154 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
7155 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007156 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007157 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007158 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getABITypeSize(GEPIdxTy)) {
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007159 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
7160 Offset %= TySize;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007161
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007162 // Handle silly modulus not returning values values [0..TySize).
7163 if (Offset < 0) {
7164 --FirstIdx;
7165 Offset += TySize;
7166 assert(Offset >= 0);
7167 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007168 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize &&"Out of range offset");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007169 }
7170
7171 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007172
7173 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
7174 while (Offset) {
7175 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7176 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007177 if (Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes()) {
7178 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
7179 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007180
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007181 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
7182 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType(Elt);
7183 } else {
7184 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7185 Offset = 0;
7186 OrigBase = 0;
7187 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007188 } else if (isa<ArrayType>(GEPIdxTy) || isa<VectorType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7189 const SequentialType *STy = cast<SequentialType>(GEPIdxTy);
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007190 if (uint64_t EltSize = TD->getABITypeSize(STy->getElementType())){
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007191 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
7192 Offset %= EltSize;
7193 } else {
7194 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, 0));
7195 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007196 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType();
7197 } else {
7198 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7199 Offset = 0;
7200 OrigBase = 0;
7201 }
7202 }
7203 if (OrigBase) {
7204 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
7205 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
7206 // two.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007207 Instruction *NGEP = GetElementPtrInst::Create(OrigBase,
7208 NewIndices.begin(),
7209 NewIndices.end(), "");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007210 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
7211 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
7212
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007213 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
7214 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7215 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
7216 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7217 }
7218 }
7219 }
7220 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007221 }
7222
7223 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7224}
7225
7226
7227
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007228/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
7229/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007230/// cases.
7231/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
7232Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7233 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7234 return Result;
7235
7236 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7237 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7238 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007239 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7240 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007241
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007242 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
7243 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00007244 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
7245 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007246 KnownZero, KnownOne))
7247 return &CI;
7248
7249 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
7250 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007251 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
7252 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007253 return 0;
7254
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007255 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007256 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007257 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
7258 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007259 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007260 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007261 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
7262 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
7263 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
7264 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007265 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007266 bool DoXForm;
7267 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7268 default:
7269 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
7270 // get here because of the check above.
7271 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
7272 case Instruction::Trunc:
7273 DoXForm = true;
7274 break;
7275 case Instruction::ZExt:
7276 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
7277 break;
7278 case Instruction::SExt:
7279 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
7280 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007281 }
7282
7283 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007284 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
7285 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007286 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
7287 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7288 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
7289 case Instruction::Trunc:
7290 case Instruction::BitCast:
7291 // Just replace this cast with the result.
7292 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7293 case Instruction::ZExt: {
7294 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
7295 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00007296 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
7297 SrcBitSize));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007298 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Res, C);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007299 }
7300 case Instruction::SExt:
7301 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007302 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007303 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
7304 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007305 }
7306 }
7307 }
7308
7309 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
7310 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
7311
7312 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7313 case Instruction::Add:
7314 case Instruction::Mul:
7315 case Instruction::And:
7316 case Instruction::Or:
7317 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007318 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007319 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
7320 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7321 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7322 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
7323 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007324 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
7325 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00007326 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007327 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7328 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007329 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007330 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007331 }
7332 }
7333
7334 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
7335 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
7336 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007337 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007338 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007339 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007340 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007341 }
7342 break;
7343 case Instruction::SDiv:
7344 case Instruction::UDiv:
7345 case Instruction::SRem:
7346 case Instruction::URem:
7347 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
7348 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
7349 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7350 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7351 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007352 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
7353 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007354 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7355 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7356 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7357 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007358 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007359 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
7360 }
7361 }
7362 break;
7363
7364 case Instruction::Shl:
7365 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
7366 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
7367 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
7368 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
7369 // in the value.
7370 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
7371 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007372 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
7373 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
7374 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007375 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007376 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007377 }
7378 break;
7379 case Instruction::AShr:
7380 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
7381 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
7382 // simplifications.
7383 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
7384 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007385 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007386 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
7387 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007388 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007389 }
7390 }
7391 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007392 }
7393 return 0;
7394}
7395
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007396Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007397 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7398 return Result;
7399
7400 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7401 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007402 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7403 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007404
7405 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
7406 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7407 default: break;
7408 case Instruction::LShr:
7409 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
7410 // are already zeros.
7411 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007412 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007413
7414 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00007415 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007416 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
7417 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007418 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
7419 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
7420
7421 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
7422 // shift.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007423 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
7424 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
7425 Ty, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007426 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007427 }
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007428 } else { // This is a variable shr.
7429
7430 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
7431 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
7432 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007433 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007434 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
7435
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007436 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007437 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007438 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007439 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V,
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007440 SrcI->getOperand(0),
7441 "tmp"), CI);
7442 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007443 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007444 }
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007445 }
7446 break;
7447 }
7448 }
7449
7450 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007451}
7452
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007453/// transformZExtICmp - Transform (zext icmp) to bitwise / integer operations
7454/// in order to eliminate the icmp.
7455Instruction *InstCombiner::transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
7456 bool DoXform) {
7457 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7458 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7459 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7460 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7461 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7462
7463 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
7464 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
7465 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7466 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
7467 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7468
7469 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7470 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7471 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007472 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In, Sh,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007473 In->getName()+".lobit"),
7474 CI);
7475 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007476 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007477 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7478
7479 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
7480 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007481 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007482 In->getName()+".not"),
7483 CI);
7484 }
7485
7486 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7487 }
7488
7489
7490
7491 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7492 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7493 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7494 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7495 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7496 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7497 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7498 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7499 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
7500 // This only works for EQ and NE
7501 ICI->isEquality()) {
7502 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
7503 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
7504 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
7505 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
7506 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
7507
7508 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
7509 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
7510 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7511
7512 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
7513 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
7514 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
7515 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
7516 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
7517 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
7518 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7519 }
7520
7521 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
7522 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7523 if (ShiftAmt) {
7524 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
7525 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007526 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007527 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
7528 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
7529 }
7530
7531 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
7532 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007533 In = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007534 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
7535 }
7536
7537 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
7538 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7539 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007540 return CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007541 }
7542 }
7543 }
7544
7545 return 0;
7546}
7547
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007548Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007549 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
7550 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7551 return Result;
7552
7553 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7554
7555 // If this is a cast of a cast
7556 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007557 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
7558 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
7559 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
7560 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
7561 // Get the sizes of the types involved
7562 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007563 uint32_t SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7564 uint32_t MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7565 uint32_t DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007566 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
7567 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
7568 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00007569 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00007570 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007571 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007572 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007573 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
7574 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
7575 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
7576 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007577 And = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007578 }
7579 return And;
7580 }
7581 }
7582 }
7583
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007584 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src))
7585 return transformZExtICmp(ICI, CI);
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00007586
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007587 BinaryOperator *SrcI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Src);
7588 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
7589 // zext (or icmp, icmp) --> or (zext icmp), (zext icmp) if at least one
7590 // of the (zext icmp) will be transformed.
7591 ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0));
7592 ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(1));
7593 if (LHS && RHS && LHS->hasOneUse() && RHS->hasOneUse() &&
7594 (transformZExtICmp(LHS, CI, false) ||
7595 transformZExtICmp(RHS, CI, false))) {
7596 Value *LCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, LHS, CI.getType(), CI);
7597 Value *RCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, RHS, CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007598 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::Or, LCast, RCast);
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00007599 }
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007600 }
7601
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007602 return 0;
7603}
7604
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007605Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007606 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7607 return I;
7608
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007609 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7610
7611 // sext (x <s 0) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
7612 // sext (x >s -1) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
7613 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src)) {
7614 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7615 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7616 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7617 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7618 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7619
7620 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
7621 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
7622 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7623 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())){
7624 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7625 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7626 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007627 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(In, Sh,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00007628 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007629 CI);
7630 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007631 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007632 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7633
7634 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007635 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(In,
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007636 In->getName()+".not"), CI);
7637
7638 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7639 }
7640 }
7641 }
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00007642
7643 // See if the value being truncated is already sign extended. If so, just
7644 // eliminate the trunc/sext pair.
7645 if (getOpcode(Src) == Instruction::Trunc) {
7646 Value *Op = cast<User>(Src)->getOperand(0);
7647 unsigned OpBits = cast<IntegerType>(Op->getType())->getBitWidth();
7648 unsigned MidBits = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
7649 unsigned DestBits = cast<IntegerType>(CI.getType())->getBitWidth();
7650 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op);
7651
7652 if (OpBits == DestBits) {
7653 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 24 sign
7654 // bits, it is already ready.
7655 if (NumSignBits > DestBits-MidBits)
7656 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op);
7657 } else if (OpBits < DestBits) {
7658 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i64. If Op has more than 24 sign
7659 // bits, just sext from i32.
7660 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
7661 return new SExtInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
7662 } else {
7663 // Op is i64, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 56 sign
7664 // bits, just truncate to i32.
7665 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
7666 return new TruncInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
7667 }
7668 }
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00007669
7670 // If the input is a shl/ashr pair of a same constant, then this is a sign
7671 // extension from a smaller value. If we could trust arbitrary bitwidth
7672 // integers, we could turn this into a truncate to the smaller bit and then
7673 // use a sext for the whole extension. Since we don't, look deeper and check
7674 // for a truncate. If the source and dest are the same type, eliminate the
7675 // trunc and extend and just do shifts. For example, turn:
7676 // %a = trunc i32 %i to i8
7677 // %b = shl i8 %a, 6
7678 // %c = ashr i8 %b, 6
7679 // %d = sext i8 %c to i32
7680 // into:
7681 // %a = shl i32 %i, 30
7682 // %d = ashr i32 %a, 30
7683 Value *A = 0;
7684 ConstantInt *BA = 0, *CA = 0;
7685 if (match(Src, m_AShr(m_Shl(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(BA)),
7686 m_ConstantInt(CA))) &&
7687 BA == CA && isa<TruncInst>(A)) {
7688 Value *I = cast<TruncInst>(A)->getOperand(0);
7689 if (I->getType() == CI.getType()) {
7690 unsigned MidSize = Src->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7691 unsigned SrcDstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7692 unsigned ShAmt = CA->getZExtValue()+SrcDstSize-MidSize;
7693 Constant *ShAmtV = ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), ShAmt);
7694 I = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I, ShAmtV,
7695 CI.getName()), CI);
7696 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(I, ShAmtV);
7697 }
7698 }
7699
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007700 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007701}
7702
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007703/// FitsInFPType - Return a Constant* for the specified FP constant if it fits
7704/// in the specified FP type without changing its value.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007705static Constant *FitsInFPType(ConstantFP *CFP, const fltSemantics &Sem) {
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007706 APFloat F = CFP->getValueAPF();
7707 if (F.convert(Sem, APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven) == APFloat::opOK)
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007708 return ConstantFP::get(F);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007709 return 0;
7710}
7711
7712/// LookThroughFPExtensions - If this is an fp extension instruction, look
7713/// through it until we get the source value.
7714static Value *LookThroughFPExtensions(Value *V) {
7715 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
7716 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FPExt)
7717 return LookThroughFPExtensions(I->getOperand(0));
7718
7719 // If this value is a constant, return the constant in the smallest FP type
7720 // that can accurately represent it. This allows us to turn
7721 // (float)((double)X+2.0) into x+2.0f.
7722 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V)) {
7723 if (CFP->getType() == Type::PPC_FP128Ty)
7724 return V; // No constant folding of this.
7725 // See if the value can be truncated to float and then reextended.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007726 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEsingle))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007727 return V;
7728 if (CFP->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
7729 return V; // Won't shrink.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007730 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEdouble))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007731 return V;
7732 // Don't try to shrink to various long double types.
7733 }
7734
7735 return V;
7736}
7737
7738Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI) {
7739 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7740 return I;
7741
7742 // If we have fptrunc(add (fpextend x), (fpextend y)), where x and y are
7743 // smaller than the destination type, we can eliminate the truncate by doing
7744 // the add as the smaller type. This applies to add/sub/mul/div as well as
7745 // many builtins (sqrt, etc).
7746 BinaryOperator *OpI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(CI.getOperand(0));
7747 if (OpI && OpI->hasOneUse()) {
7748 switch (OpI->getOpcode()) {
7749 default: break;
7750 case Instruction::Add:
7751 case Instruction::Sub:
7752 case Instruction::Mul:
7753 case Instruction::FDiv:
7754 case Instruction::FRem:
7755 const Type *SrcTy = OpI->getType();
7756 Value *LHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(0));
7757 Value *RHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(1));
7758 if (LHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy &&
7759 RHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy) {
7760 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7761 // If the source types were both smaller than the destination type of
7762 // the cast, do this xform.
7763 if (LHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize &&
7764 RHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize) {
7765 LHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, LHSTrunc,
7766 CI.getType(), CI);
7767 RHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, RHSTrunc,
7768 CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007769 return BinaryOperator::Create(OpI->getOpcode(), LHSTrunc, RHSTrunc);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007770 }
7771 }
7772 break;
7773 }
7774 }
7775 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007776}
7777
7778Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
7779 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7780}
7781
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007782Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00007783 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
7784 if (OpI == 0)
7785 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
7786
7787 // fptoui(uitofp(X)) --> X
7788 // fptoui(sitofp(X)) --> X
7789 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
7790 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
7791 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
7792 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
7793 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
7794 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
7795 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() < /*extra bit for sign */
7796 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
7797 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007798
7799 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007800}
7801
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007802Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00007803 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
7804 if (OpI == 0)
7805 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
7806
7807 // fptosi(sitofp(X)) --> X
7808 // fptosi(uitofp(X)) --> X
7809 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
7810 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
7811 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
7812 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
7813 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
7814 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
7815 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <=
7816 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
7817 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007818
7819 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007820}
7821
7822Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
7823 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7824}
7825
7826Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
7827 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7828}
7829
7830Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007831 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007832}
7833
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00007834Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI) {
7835 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7836 return I;
7837
7838 const Type *DestPointee = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType())->getElementType();
7839 if (!DestPointee->isSized()) return 0;
7840
7841 // If this is inttoptr(add (ptrtoint x), cst), try to turn this into a GEP.
7842 ConstantInt *Cst;
7843 Value *X;
7844 if (match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Cast<PtrToIntInst>(m_Value(X)),
7845 m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
7846 // If the source and destination operands have the same type, see if this
7847 // is a single-index GEP.
7848 if (X->getType() == CI.getType()) {
7849 // Get the size of the pointee type.
Bill Wendlingb9d4f8d2008-03-14 05:12:19 +00007850 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00007851
7852 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
7853 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
7854 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
7855
7856 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
7857 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
7858 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007859 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, ConstantInt::get(Offset));
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00007860 }
7861 }
7862 // TODO: Could handle other cases, e.g. where add is indexing into field of
7863 // struct etc.
7864 } else if (CI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
7865 match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
7866 // Otherwise, if this is inttoptr(add x, cst), try to turn this into an
7867 // "inttoptr+GEP" instead of "add+intptr".
7868
7869 // Get the size of the pointee type.
7870 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
7871
7872 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
7873 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
7874 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
7875
7876 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
7877 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
7878 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
7879
7880 Instruction *P = InsertNewInstBefore(new IntToPtrInst(X, CI.getType(),
7881 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007882 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(P, ConstantInt::get(Offset), "tmp");
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00007883 }
7884 }
7885 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007886}
7887
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007888Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007889 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
7890 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
7891 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7892 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7893 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
7894
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007895 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007896 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7897 return Result;
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007898 } else if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
7899 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
7900 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007901 } else {
7902 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7903 return Result;
7904 }
7905
7906
7907 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
7908 // be replaced by the operand.
7909 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
7910 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
7911
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007912 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007913 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
7914 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
7915 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
7916
Nate Begeman83ad90a2008-03-31 00:22:16 +00007917 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the bitcast, which is
7918 // required for changing types.
7919 if (SrcPTy->getAddressSpace() != DstPTy->getAddressSpace())
7920 return 0;
7921
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007922 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
7923 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
7924 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
7925 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
7926 return V;
7927
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007928 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
7929 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007930 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
7931 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
7932 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
7933 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
7934 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
7935 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
7936 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
7937 ++NumZeros;
7938 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007939
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007940 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
7941 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
7942 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007943 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
7944 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007945 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007946 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00007947
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007948 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
7949 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
7950 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
7951 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00007952 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
7953 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007954 SVI->getType()->getNumElements()) {
7955 CastInst *Tmp;
7956 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
7957 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
7958 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
7959 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
7960 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
7961 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
7962 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007963 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7964 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
7965 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7966 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007967 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
7968 // know the vector types match #elts.
7969 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00007970 }
7971 }
7972 }
7973 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00007974 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00007975}
7976
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007977/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
7978/// %C = or %A, %B
7979/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
7980/// into:
7981/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
7982/// %D = or %A, %C
7983///
7984/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
7985/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
7986/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
7987///
7988static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
7989 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7990 case Instruction::Add:
7991 case Instruction::Mul:
7992 case Instruction::And:
7993 case Instruction::Or:
7994 case Instruction::Xor:
7995 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
7996 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
7997 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00007998 case Instruction::LShr:
7999 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008000 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008001 default:
8002 return 0; // Cannot fold
8003 }
8004}
8005
8006/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
8007/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
8008static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
8009 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8010 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
8011 case Instruction::Add:
8012 case Instruction::Sub:
8013 case Instruction::Or:
8014 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008015 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008016 case Instruction::LShr:
8017 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008018 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008019 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00008020 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008021 case Instruction::Mul:
8022 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
8023 }
8024}
8025
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008026/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
8027/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
8028Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
8029 Instruction *FI) {
8030 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
8031 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
8032 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008033 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008034 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
8035 return 0;
8036 } else {
8037 return 0; // unknown unary op.
8038 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008039
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008040 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008041 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
8042 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008043 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008044 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008045 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008046 }
8047
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008048 // Only handle binary operators here.
8049 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008050 return 0;
8051
8052 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
8053 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
8054 bool MatchIsOpZero;
8055 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8056 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8057 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8058 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8059 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8060 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8061 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8062 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8063 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8064 MatchIsOpZero = false;
8065 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
8066 return 0;
8067 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8068 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8069 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8070 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8071 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8072 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8073 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8074 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8075 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8076 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8077 } else {
8078 return 0;
8079 }
8080
8081 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008082 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
8083 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008084 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
8085
8086 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
8087 if (MatchIsOpZero)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008088 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008089 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008090 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008091 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00008092 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
8093 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008094}
8095
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008096Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008097 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
8098 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8099 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8100
8101 // select true, X, Y -> X
8102 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008103 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008104 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008105
8106 // select C, X, X -> X
8107 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
8108 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8109
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008110 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
8111 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8112 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
8113 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8114 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
8115 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8116 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8117 else
8118 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8119 }
8120
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008121 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008122 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008123 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008124 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008125 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008126 } else {
8127 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
8128 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008129 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008130 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008131 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008132 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008133 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008134 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008135 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008136 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008137 } else {
8138 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
8139 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008140 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008141 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008142 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008143 }
8144 }
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008145
8146 // select a, b, a -> a&b
8147 // select a, a, b -> a|b
8148 if (CondVal == TrueVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008149 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008150 else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008151 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008152 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008153
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008154 // Selecting between two integer constants?
8155 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
8156 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008157 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008158 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008159 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008160 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008161 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008162 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008163 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008164 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008165 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008166 }
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008167
8168 // FIXME: Turn select 0/-1 and -1/0 into sext from condition!
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008169
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008170 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008171
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008172 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008173 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008174 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008175 if (IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && CmpCst->isZero()) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008176 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008177 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008178 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008179 uint32_t Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008180 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008181 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, X,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008182 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008183 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
8184
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008185 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
8186 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
8187 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008188 uint32_t SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8189 uint32_t SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008190 if (SRASize < SISize)
8191 opc = Instruction::SExt;
8192 else if (SRASize > SISize)
8193 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008194 return CastInst::Create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008195 }
8196 }
8197
8198
8199 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008200 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008201 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
8202 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008203 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00008204 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008205 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
8206 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
8207 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008208 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
8209 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
8210 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008211 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
8212 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008213 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
8214 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008215 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008216 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008217 Value *V = ICA;
8218 if (ShouldNotVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008219 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008220 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
8221 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
8222 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008223 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008224 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008225
8226 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008227 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
8228 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008229 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008230 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8231 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8232 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8233 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8234 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8235 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8236 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8237 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8238 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008239 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008240 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008241 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008242 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008243 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8244 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
8245
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008246 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008247 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008248 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8249 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8250 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8251 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8252 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8253 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8254 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8255 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8256 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
8257 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8258 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008259 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008260 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
8261 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8262 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
8263 }
8264 }
8265
8266 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
8267 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal)) {
8268 if (ICI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
8269 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
8270 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8271 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8272 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
8273 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8274 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8275 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
8276
8277 } else if (ICI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
8278 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
8279 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8280 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8281 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
8282 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Chris Lattnerfbede522004-04-11 01:39:19 +00008283 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008284 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
8285 }
8286 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008287
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008288 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8289 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8290 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008291 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
8292
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008293 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
8294 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
8295 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
8296 return IV;
8297
8298 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
8299 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008300 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8301 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8302 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
8303 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8304 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8305 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
8306 }
8307
8308 if (AddOp) {
8309 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
8310 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
8311 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
8312 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
8313 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
8314 }
8315
8316 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008317 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
8318 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
8319 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
8320 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
8321 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
8322 } else {
8323 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008324 BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008325 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008326
8327 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
8328 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
8329 if (AddOp != TI)
8330 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
8331 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008332 SelectInst::Create(CondVal, NewTrueOp,
8333 NewFalseOp, SI.getName() + ".p");
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008334
8335 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008336 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008337 }
8338 }
8339 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008340
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008341 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008342 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008343 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
8344 // transformation we are doing here.
8345 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8346 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8347 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
8348 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
8349 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8350 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
8351 OpToFold = 1;
8352 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
8353 OpToFold = 2;
8354 }
8355
8356 if (OpToFold) {
8357 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008358 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008359 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(),
8360 TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008361 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008362 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008363 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008364 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008365 else {
8366 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
8367 }
8368 }
8369 }
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00008370
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008371 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8372 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8373 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8374 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
8375 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8376 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
8377 OpToFold = 1;
8378 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
8379 OpToFold = 2;
8380 }
8381
8382 if (OpToFold) {
8383 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008384 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008385 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), C,
8386 FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008387 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008388 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008389 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008390 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008391 else
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008392 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008393 }
8394 }
8395 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00008396
8397 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
8398 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
8399 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
8400 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
8401 return &SI;
8402 }
8403
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008404 return 0;
8405}
8406
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008407/// EnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer points to an object that
8408/// we control, modify the object's alignment to PrefAlign. This isn't
8409/// often possible though. If alignment is important, a more reliable approach
8410/// is to simply align all global variables and allocation instructions to
8411/// their preferred alignment from the beginning.
8412///
8413static unsigned EnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8414 unsigned Align, unsigned PrefAlign) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008415
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008416 User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V);
8417 if (!U) return Align;
8418
8419 switch (getOpcode(U)) {
8420 default: break;
8421 case Instruction::BitCast:
8422 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
8423 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008424 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
8425 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
Gabor Greif52ed3632008-06-12 21:51:29 +00008426 for (User::op_iterator i = U->op_begin() + 1, e = U->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00008427 if (!isa<Constant>(*i) ||
8428 !cast<Constant>(*i)->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008429 AllZeroOperands = false;
8430 break;
8431 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008432
8433 if (AllZeroOperands) {
8434 // Treat this like a bitcast.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008435 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008436 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008437 break;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008438 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008439 }
8440
8441 if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
8442 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
8443 // of the global.
8444 if (!GV->isDeclaration()) {
8445 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8446 Align = PrefAlign;
8447 }
8448 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
8449 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up. We
8450 // don't do this for malloc, because some systems can't respect the request.
8451 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI)) {
8452 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8453 Align = PrefAlign;
8454 }
8455 }
8456
8457 return Align;
8458}
8459
8460/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
8461/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
8462/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
8463/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
8464unsigned InstCombiner::GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8465 unsigned PrefAlign) {
8466 unsigned BitWidth = TD ? TD->getTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()) :
8467 sizeof(PrefAlign) * CHAR_BIT;
8468 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
8469 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
8470 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
8471 unsigned TrailZ = KnownZero.countTrailingOnes();
8472 unsigned Align = 1u << std::min(BitWidth - 1, TrailZ);
8473
8474 if (PrefAlign > Align)
8475 Align = EnforceKnownAlignment(V, Align, PrefAlign);
8476
8477 // We don't need to make any adjustment.
8478 return Align;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008479}
8480
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008481Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008482 unsigned DstAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1));
8483 unsigned SrcAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008484 unsigned MinAlign = std::min(DstAlign, SrcAlign);
8485 unsigned CopyAlign = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
8486
8487 if (CopyAlign < MinAlign) {
8488 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, MinAlign));
8489 return MI;
8490 }
8491
8492 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
8493 // load/store.
8494 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getOperand(3));
8495 if (MemOpLength == 0) return 0;
8496
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008497 // Source and destination pointer types are always "i8*" for intrinsic. See
8498 // if the size is something we can handle with a single primitive load/store.
8499 // A single load+store correctly handles overlapping memory in the memmove
8500 // case.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008501 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008502 if (Size == 0) return MI; // Delete this mem transfer.
8503
8504 if (Size > 8 || (Size&(Size-1)))
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008505 return 0; // If not 1/2/4/8 bytes, exit.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008506
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008507 // Use an integer load+store unless we can find something better.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008508 Type *NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(IntegerType::get(Size<<3));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008509
8510 // Memcpy forces the use of i8* for the source and destination. That means
8511 // that if you're using memcpy to move one double around, you'll get a cast
8512 // from double* to i8*. We'd much rather use a double load+store rather than
8513 // an i64 load+store, here because this improves the odds that the source or
8514 // dest address will be promotable. See if we can find a better type than the
8515 // integer datatype.
8516 if (Value *Op = getBitCastOperand(MI->getOperand(1))) {
8517 const Type *SrcETy = cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getElementType();
8518 if (SrcETy->isSized() && TD->getTypeStoreSize(SrcETy) == Size) {
8519 // The SrcETy might be something like {{{double}}} or [1 x double]. Rip
8520 // down through these levels if so.
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00008521 while (!SrcETy->isSingleValueType()) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008522 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcETy)) {
8523 if (STy->getNumElements() == 1)
8524 SrcETy = STy->getElementType(0);
8525 else
8526 break;
8527 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcETy)) {
8528 if (ATy->getNumElements() == 1)
8529 SrcETy = ATy->getElementType();
8530 else
8531 break;
8532 } else
8533 break;
8534 }
8535
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00008536 if (SrcETy->isSingleValueType())
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008537 NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(SrcETy);
8538 }
8539 }
8540
8541
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008542 // If the memcpy/memmove provides better alignment info than we can
8543 // infer, use it.
8544 SrcAlign = std::max(SrcAlign, CopyAlign);
8545 DstAlign = std::max(DstAlign, CopyAlign);
8546
8547 Value *Src = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(2), NewPtrTy, *MI);
8548 Value *Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(1), NewPtrTy, *MI);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008549 Instruction *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, SrcAlign);
8550 InsertNewInstBefore(L, *MI);
8551 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, DstAlign), *MI);
8552
8553 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
8554 MI->setOperand(3, Constant::getNullValue(MemOpLength->getType()));
8555 return MI;
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008556}
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008557
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008558Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI) {
8559 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest());
8560 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
8561 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
8562 return MI;
8563 }
8564
8565 // Extract the length and alignment and fill if they are constant.
8566 ConstantInt *LenC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getLength());
8567 ConstantInt *FillC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getValue());
8568 if (!LenC || !FillC || FillC->getType() != Type::Int8Ty)
8569 return 0;
8570 uint64_t Len = LenC->getZExtValue();
8571 Alignment = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
8572
8573 // If the length is zero, this is a no-op
8574 if (Len == 0) return MI; // memset(d,c,0,a) -> noop
8575
8576 // memset(s,c,n) -> store s, c (for n=1,2,4,8)
8577 if (Len <= 8 && isPowerOf2_32((uint32_t)Len)) {
8578 const Type *ITy = IntegerType::get(Len*8); // n=1 -> i8.
8579
8580 Value *Dest = MI->getDest();
8581 Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(Dest, PointerType::getUnqual(ITy), *MI);
8582
8583 // Alignment 0 is identity for alignment 1 for memset, but not store.
8584 if (Alignment == 0) Alignment = 1;
8585
8586 // Extract the fill value and store.
8587 uint64_t Fill = FillC->getZExtValue()*0x0101010101010101ULL;
8588 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(ConstantInt::get(ITy, Fill), Dest, false,
8589 Alignment), *MI);
8590
8591 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
8592 MI->setLength(Constant::getNullValue(LenC->getType()));
8593 return MI;
8594 }
8595
8596 return 0;
8597}
8598
8599
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008600/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
8601/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
8602/// the heavy lifting.
8603///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008604Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008605 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
8606 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
8607
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008608 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
8609 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008610 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008611 bool Changed = false;
8612
8613 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
8614 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
8615 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
8616
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008617 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008618 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008619 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
8620 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
8621 // alignment is sufficient.
8622 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008623 }
8624
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008625 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
8626 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
8627 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008628 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008629 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
8630 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
8631 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00008632 Intrinsic::ID MemCpyID;
8633 if (CI.getOperand(3)->getType() == Type::Int32Ty)
8634 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i32;
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00008635 else
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00008636 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i64;
8637 CI.setOperand(0, Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, MemCpyID));
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008638 Changed = true;
8639 }
Chris Lattnera935db82008-05-28 05:30:41 +00008640
8641 // memmove(x,x,size) -> noop.
8642 if (MMI->getSource() == MMI->getDest())
8643 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008644 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008645
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008646 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
8647 // set, update the alignment.
8648 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008649 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemTransfer(MI))
8650 return I;
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008651 } else if (MemSetInst *MSI = dyn_cast<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
8652 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemSet(MSI))
8653 return I;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008654 }
8655
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008656 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008657 }
8658
8659 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
8660 default: break;
8661 case Intrinsic::bswap:
8662 // bswap(bswap(x)) -> x
8663 if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1)))
8664 if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap)
8665 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Operand->getOperand(1));
8666 break;
8667 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
8668 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
8669 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
8670 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
8671 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
8672 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
8673 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
8674 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
8675 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),
8676 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getType()),
8677 CI);
8678 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008679 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008680 break;
8681 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
8682 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
8683 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
8684 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), 16) >= 16) {
8685 const Type *OpPtrTy =
8686 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
8687 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2), OpPtrTy, CI);
8688 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
8689 }
8690 break;
8691 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
8692 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
8693 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008694 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
8695 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
8696 const Type *OpPtrTy =
8697 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
8698 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1), OpPtrTy, CI);
8699 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
8700 }
8701 break;
8702
8703 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
8704 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
8705 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
8706 uint64_t UndefElts;
8707 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
8708 UndefElts)) {
8709 II->setOperand(1, V);
8710 return II;
8711 }
8712 break;
8713 }
8714
8715 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
8716 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
8717 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
8718 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008719
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008720 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
8721 bool AllEltsOk = true;
8722 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
8723 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
8724 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
8725 AllEltsOk = false;
8726 break;
8727 }
8728 }
8729
8730 if (AllEltsOk) {
8731 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
8732 Value *Op0 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),Mask->getType(),CI);
8733 Value *Op1 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2),Mask->getType(),CI);
8734 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008735
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008736 // Only extract each element once.
8737 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
8738 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
8739
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008740 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008741 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
8742 continue;
8743 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
8744 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
8745
8746 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
8747 Instruction *Elt =
8748 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
8749 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
8750 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008751 }
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008752
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008753 // Insert this value into the result vector.
8754 Result = InsertElementInst::Create(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx],
8755 i, "tmp");
8756 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008757 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008758 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008759 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008760 }
8761 break;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008762
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008763 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
8764 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
8765 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
8766 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
8767 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
8768 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
8769 if (&*++BI == II)
8770 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00008771 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008772 }
8773
8774 // Scan down this block to see if there is another stack restore in the
8775 // same block without an intervening call/alloca.
8776 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
8777 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
8778 bool CannotRemove = false;
8779 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
8780 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI)) {
8781 CannotRemove = true;
8782 break;
8783 }
Chris Lattneraa0bf522008-06-25 05:59:28 +00008784 if (CallInst *BCI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(BI)) {
8785 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BCI)) {
8786 // If there is a stackrestore below this one, remove this one.
8787 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stackrestore)
8788 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
8789 // Otherwise, ignore the intrinsic.
8790 } else {
8791 // If we found a non-intrinsic call, we can't remove the stack
8792 // restore.
Chris Lattnerbf1d8a72008-02-18 06:12:38 +00008793 CannotRemove = true;
8794 break;
8795 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008796 }
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00008797 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008798
8799 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
8800 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
8801 if (!CannotRemove && (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)))
8802 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
8803 break;
8804 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008805 }
8806
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008807 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008808}
8809
8810// InvokeInst simplification
8811//
8812Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008813 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008814}
8815
Dale Johannesenda30ccb2008-04-25 21:16:07 +00008816/// isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast - If this cast does not affect the value
8817/// passed through the varargs area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00008818static bool isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(const CallSite CS,
8819 const CastInst * const CI,
8820 const TargetData * const TD,
8821 const int ix) {
8822 if (!CI->isLosslessCast())
8823 return false;
8824
8825 // The size of ByVal arguments is derived from the type, so we
8826 // can't change to a type with a different size. If the size were
8827 // passed explicitly we could avoid this check.
8828 if (!CS.paramHasAttr(ix, ParamAttr::ByVal))
8829 return true;
8830
8831 const Type* SrcTy =
8832 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
8833 const Type* DstTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
8834 if (!SrcTy->isSized() || !DstTy->isSized())
8835 return false;
8836 if (TD->getABITypeSize(SrcTy) != TD->getABITypeSize(DstTy))
8837 return false;
8838 return true;
8839}
8840
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008841// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
8842//
8843Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008844 bool Changed = false;
8845
8846 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
8847 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008848 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
8849
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008850 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008851
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00008852 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
8853 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
8854 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
8855 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
8856 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008857 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00008858 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
8859 OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00008860 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
8861 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
8862 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
8863 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
8864 return 0;
8865 }
8866
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008867 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
8868 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
8869 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
8870 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008871 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00008872 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008873 CS.getInstruction());
8874
8875 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
8876 CS.getInstruction()->
8877 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
8878
8879 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
8880 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008881 BranchInst::Create(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
8882 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008883 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008884 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
8885 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008886
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00008887 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
8888 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
8889 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
8890 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
8891
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008892 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
8893 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
8894 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
Dale Johannesen63e7eb42008-04-23 01:03:05 +00008895 int ix = FTy->getNumParams() + (isa<InvokeInst>(Callee) ? 3 : 1);
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008896 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
8897 // the call.
8898 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00008899 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I, ++ix) {
8900 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I);
8901 if (CI && isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(CS, CI, TD, ix)) {
8902 *I = CI->getOperand(0);
8903 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008904 }
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00008905 }
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008906 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008907
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00008908 if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00008909 // Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00008910 CS.setDoesNotThrow();
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00008911 Changed = true;
8912 }
8913
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008914 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008915}
8916
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008917// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
8918// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
8919//
8920bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
8921 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
8922 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008923 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
8924 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008925 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +00008926 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008927 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008928 const PAListPtr &CallerPAL = CS.getParamAttrs();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008929
8930 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
8931 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
8932 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
8933 //
8934 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
8935 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008936 const Type *NewRetTy = FT->getReturnType();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008937
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008938 if (isa<StructType>(NewRetTy))
Devang Patel75e6f022008-03-11 18:04:06 +00008939 return false; // TODO: Handle multiple return values.
8940
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008941 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008942 if (OldRetTy != NewRetTy) {
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +00008943 if (Callee->isDeclaration() &&
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008944 // Conversion is ok if changing from one pointer type to another or from
8945 // a pointer to an integer of the same size.
8946 !((isa<PointerType>(OldRetTy) || OldRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
Duncan Sands34b176a2008-06-17 15:55:30 +00008947 (isa<PointerType>(NewRetTy) || NewRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType())))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00008948 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008949
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00008950 if (!Caller->use_empty() &&
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00008951 // void -> non-void is handled specially
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008952 NewRetTy != Type::VoidTy && !CastInst::isCastable(NewRetTy, OldRetTy))
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00008953 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
8954
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008955 if (!CallerPAL.isEmpty() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
8956 ParameterAttributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(0);
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008957 if (RAttrs & ParamAttr::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy))
Duncan Sands6c3470e2008-01-07 17:16:06 +00008958 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
8959 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008960
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008961 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
8962 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
8963 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
8964 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
8965 if (!Caller->use_empty())
8966 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
8967 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
8968 UI != E; ++UI)
8969 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
8970 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00008971 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008972 return false;
8973 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008974
8975 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
8976 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008977
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008978 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
8979 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
8980 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00008981 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00008982
8983 if (!CastInst::isCastable(ActTy, ParamTy))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008984 return false; // Cannot transform this parameter value.
8985
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008986 if (CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(i + 1) & ParamAttr::typeIncompatible(ParamTy))
8987 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00008988
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008989 // Converting from one pointer type to another or between a pointer and an
8990 // integer of the same size is safe even if we do not have a body.
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00008991 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008992 ((isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) || ParamTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
8993 (isa<PointerType>(ActTy) || ActTy == TD->getIntPtrType()));
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008994 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008995 }
8996
8997 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008998 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008999 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009000
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009001 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && FT->isVarArg() &&
9002 !CallerPAL.isEmpty())
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009003 // In this case we have more arguments than the new function type, but we
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009004 // won't be dropping them. Check that these extra arguments have attributes
9005 // that are compatible with being a vararg call argument.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009006 for (unsigned i = CallerPAL.getNumSlots(); i; --i) {
9007 if (CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Index <= FT->getNumParams())
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009008 break;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009009 ParameterAttributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Attrs;
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009010 if (PAttrs & ParamAttr::VarArgsIncompatible)
9011 return false;
9012 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009013
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009014 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
9015 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
9016 std::vector<Value*> Args;
9017 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009018 SmallVector<ParamAttrsWithIndex, 8> attrVec;
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009019 attrVec.reserve(NumCommonArgs);
9020
9021 // Get any return attributes.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009022 ParameterAttributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(0);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009023
9024 // If the return value is not being used, the type may not be compatible
9025 // with the existing attributes. Wipe out any problematic attributes.
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009026 RAttrs &= ~ParamAttr::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009027
9028 // Add the new return attributes.
9029 if (RAttrs)
9030 attrVec.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(0, RAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009031
9032 AI = CS.arg_begin();
9033 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9034 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
9035 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
9036 Args.push_back(*AI);
9037 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00009038 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009039 false, ParamTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009040 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009041 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009042 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009043
9044 // Add any parameter attributes.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009045 if (ParameterAttributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(i + 1))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009046 attrVec.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009047 }
9048
9049 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
9050 // now...
9051 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
9052 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
9053
9054 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009055 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009056 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlinge8156192006-12-07 01:30:32 +00009057 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
9058 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009059 } else {
9060 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
9061 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9062 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
9063 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
9064 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009065 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
9066 PTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009067 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009068 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
9069 Args.push_back(Cast);
9070 } else {
9071 Args.push_back(*AI);
9072 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009073
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009074 // Add any parameter attributes.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009075 if (ParameterAttributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(i + 1))
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009076 attrVec.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
9077 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009078 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009079 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009080
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009081 if (NewRetTy == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009082 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009083
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009084 const PAListPtr &NewCallerPAL = PAListPtr::get(attrVec.begin(),attrVec.end());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009085
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009086 Instruction *NC;
9087 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009088 NC = InvokeInst::Create(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009089 Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9090 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +00009091 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009092 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setParamAttrs(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009093 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009094 NC = CallInst::Create(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9095 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009096 CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
9097 if (CI->isTailCall())
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +00009098 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009099 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009100 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setParamAttrs(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009101 }
9102
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009103 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009104 Value *NV = NC;
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009105 if (OldRetTy != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009106 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009107 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009108 OldRetTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009109 NV = NC = CastInst::Create(opcode, NC, OldRetTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009110
9111 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
9112 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
9113 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +00009114 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009115 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
9116 } else {
9117 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
9118 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
9119 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009120 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009121 } else {
Chris Lattnerc30bda72004-10-17 21:22:38 +00009122 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009123 }
9124 }
9125
9126 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9127 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00009128 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009129 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009130 return true;
9131}
9132
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009133// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
9134// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
9135//
9136Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
9137 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
9138 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9139 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009140 const PAListPtr &Attrs = CS.getParamAttrs();
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009141
9142 // If the call already has the 'nest' attribute somewhere then give up -
9143 // otherwise 'nest' would occur twice after splicing in the chain.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009144 if (Attrs.hasAttrSomewhere(ParamAttr::Nest))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009145 return 0;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009146
9147 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
9148 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
9149
Anton Korobeynikov0b12ecf2008-05-07 22:54:15 +00009150 Function *NestF = cast<Function>(Tramp->getOperand(2)->stripPointerCasts());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009151 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
9152 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
9153
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009154 const PAListPtr &NestAttrs = NestF->getParamAttrs();
9155 if (!NestAttrs.isEmpty()) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009156 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
9157 const Type *NestTy = 0;
Dale Johannesen0d51e7e2008-02-19 21:38:47 +00009158 ParameterAttributes NestAttr = ParamAttr::None;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009159
9160 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
9161 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
9162 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009163 if (NestAttrs.paramHasAttr(NestIdx, ParamAttr::Nest)) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009164 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
9165 NestTy = *I;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009166 NestAttr = NestAttrs.getParamAttrs(NestIdx);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009167 break;
9168 }
9169
9170 if (NestTy) {
9171 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
9172 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
9173 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
9174
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009175 SmallVector<ParamAttrsWithIndex, 8> NewAttrs;
9176 NewAttrs.reserve(Attrs.getNumSlots() + 1);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009177
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009178 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009179 // mean appending it. Likewise for attributes.
9180
9181 // Add any function result attributes.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009182 if (ParameterAttributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttrs(0))
9183 NewAttrs.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009184
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009185 {
9186 unsigned Idx = 1;
9187 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
9188 do {
9189 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009190 // Add the chain argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009191 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
9192 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
9193 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
9194 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009195 NewAttrs.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009196 }
9197
9198 if (I == E)
9199 break;
9200
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009201 // Add the original argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009202 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009203 if (ParameterAttributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttrs(Idx))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009204 NewAttrs.push_back
9205 (ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009206
9207 ++Idx, ++I;
9208 } while (1);
9209 }
9210
9211 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
9212 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009213 // with the chain parameter inserted.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009214
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009215 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009216 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
9217
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009218 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009219 // mean appending it.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009220 {
9221 unsigned Idx = 1;
9222 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
9223 E = FTy->param_end();
9224
9225 do {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009226 if (Idx == NestIdx)
9227 // Add the chain's type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009228 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009229
9230 if (I == E)
9231 break;
9232
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009233 // Add the original type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009234 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009235
9236 ++Idx, ++I;
9237 } while (1);
9238 }
9239
9240 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
9241 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9242 FunctionType *NewFTy =
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009243 FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes, FTy->isVarArg());
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009244 Constant *NewCallee = NestF->getType() == PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy) ?
9245 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy));
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009246 const PAListPtr &NewPAL = PAListPtr::get(NewAttrs.begin(),NewAttrs.end());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009247
9248 Instruction *NewCaller;
9249 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009250 NewCaller = InvokeInst::Create(NewCallee,
9251 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9252 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9253 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009254 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009255 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setParamAttrs(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009256 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009257 NewCaller = CallInst::Create(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9258 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009259 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
9260 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
9261 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
9262 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009263 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setParamAttrs(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009264 }
9265 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9266 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
9267 Caller->eraseFromParent();
9268 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
9269 return 0;
9270 }
9271 }
9272
9273 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
9274 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
9275 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9276 Constant *NewCallee =
9277 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
9278 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
9279 return CS.getInstruction();
9280}
9281
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009282/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
9283/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
9284/// and a single binop.
9285Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9286 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009287 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
9288 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009289 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009290 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9291 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
9292
9293 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
9294 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009295
9296 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
9297 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009298 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009299 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009300 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009301 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009302 // types or GEP's with different index types.
9303 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
9304 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009305 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009306
9307 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
9308 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
9309 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
9310 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
9311 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009312
9313 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
9314 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
9315 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009316 }
9317
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009318 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
9319
9320 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
9321 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
9322 // hide them behind a phi.
9323 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
9324 return 0;
9325
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009326 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009327 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009328 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009329 if (LHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009330 NewLHS = PHINode::Create(LHSType,
9331 FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009332 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9333 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009334 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
9335 LHSVal = NewLHS;
9336 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009337
9338 if (RHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009339 NewRHS = PHINode::Create(RHSType,
9340 FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009341 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9342 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009343 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
9344 RHSVal = NewRHS;
9345 }
9346
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009347 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
9348 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9349 if (NewLHS) {
9350 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
9351 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9352 }
9353 if (NewRHS) {
9354 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
9355 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9356 }
9357 }
9358
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009359 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009360 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009361 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009362 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009363 RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009364 else {
9365 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009366 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009367 }
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009368}
9369
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009370/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
9371/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
9372/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
9373/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009374///
9375/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
9376/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
9377/// to a register.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009378static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
9379 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
9380
9381 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
9382 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
9383 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009384
9385 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
9386 // profitable to do this xform.
9387 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
9388 bool isAddressTaken = false;
9389 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
9390 UI != E; ++UI) {
9391 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
9392 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
9393 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
9394 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
9395 }
9396 isAddressTaken = true;
9397 break;
9398 }
9399
9400 if (!isAddressTaken)
9401 return false;
9402 }
9403
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009404 return true;
9405}
9406
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009407
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009408// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
9409// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
9410// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
9411Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9412 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
9413
9414 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
9415 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
9416 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
9417 // code size and simplifying code.
9418 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
9419 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009420 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009421 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
9422 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009423 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009424 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
9425 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009426 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009427 if (ConstantOp == 0)
9428 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009429 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
9430 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
9431 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
9432 // load and the PHI.
9433 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
9434 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9435 return 0;
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +00009436
9437 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
9438 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
9439 // the path through the other successor.
9440 if (isVolatile &&
9441 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
9442 return 0;
9443
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009444 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009445 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009446 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
9447 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
9448 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009449 } else {
9450 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
9451 }
9452
9453 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
9454 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9455 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
9456 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009457 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009458 return 0;
9459 if (CastSrcTy) {
9460 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
9461 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009462 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009463 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
9464 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009465 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
9466 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
9467 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9468 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +00009469
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +00009470 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
9471 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
9472 // the path through the other successor.
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +00009473 if (isVolatile &&
9474 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
9475 return 0;
9476
9477
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009478 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
9479 return 0;
9480 }
9481 }
9482
9483 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
9484 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009485 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
9486 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00009487 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00009488
9489 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9490 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009491
9492 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00009493 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9494 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
9495 if (NewInVal != InVal)
9496 InVal = 0;
9497 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9498 }
9499
9500 Value *PhiVal;
9501 if (InVal) {
9502 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
9503 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
9504 PhiVal = InVal;
9505 delete NewPN;
9506 } else {
9507 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
9508 PhiVal = NewPN;
9509 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009510
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009511 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009512 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009513 return CastInst::Create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009514 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009515 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009516 if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009517 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009518 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009519 assert(isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst) && "Unknown operation");
9520
9521 // If this was a volatile load that we are merging, make sure to loop through
9522 // and mark all the input loads as non-volatile. If we don't do this, we will
9523 // insert a new volatile load and the old ones will not be deletable.
9524 if (isVolatile)
9525 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
9526 cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->setVolatile(false);
9527
9528 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009529}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00009530
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009531/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
9532/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009533static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
9534 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009535 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
9536 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
9537
9538 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009539 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009540 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +00009541
9542 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
9543 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
9544 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009545
9546 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
9547 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009548
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009549 return false;
9550}
9551
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +00009552/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
9553/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
9554/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
9555static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
9556 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
9557 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
9558 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
9559 return true;
9560
9561 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
9562 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
9563 return false;
9564
9565 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
9566 // the value.
9567 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9568 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
9569 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
9570 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
9571 return false;
9572 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
9573 return false;
9574 }
9575
9576 return true;
9577}
9578
9579
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00009580// PHINode simplification
9581//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009582Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +00009583 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +00009584 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +00009585
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009586 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
9587 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
9588
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009589 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
9590 // reducing code size.
9591 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
9592 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
9593 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
9594 return Result;
9595
9596 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
9597 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
9598 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00009599 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
9600 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
9601 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009602 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009603 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
9604 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
9605 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
9606 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00009607
9608 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
9609 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
9610 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
9611 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
9612 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
9613 // late.
9614 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
9615 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
9616 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
9617 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
9618 }
9619 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009620
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +00009621 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
9622 // same value, for example:
9623 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
9624 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
9625 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
9626 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
9627 {
9628 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
9629 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
9630 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
9631 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
9632 ++InValNo;
9633
9634 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
9635 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
9636
9637 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
9638 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
9639 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
9640 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
9641 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
9642 break;
9643 }
9644
9645 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
9646 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
9647 // the value.
9648 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
9649 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
9650 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
9651 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
9652 }
9653 }
9654 }
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +00009655 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00009656}
9657
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009658static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
9659 Instruction *InsertPoint,
9660 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00009661 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
9662 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009663 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
9664 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
9665 // used for address computation.
9666 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
9667 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
9668 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
9669 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009670}
9671
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00009672
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009673Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009674 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00009675 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009676 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009677 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009678 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009679
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009680 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
9681 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
9682
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009683 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
9684 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
9685 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
9686
9687 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009688 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00009689
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009690 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
9691 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00009692
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009693 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009694 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP.op_begin() + 1, e = GEP.op_end();
9695 i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009696 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009697 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*i)) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00009698 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
9699 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
9700 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
9701 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
9702 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
9703 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
9704 MadeChange = true;
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009705 *i = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009706 }
9707 }
9708 }
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009709 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
9710 // to what we need. If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
9711 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
9712 // obvious.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009713 Value *Op = *i;
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009714 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00009715 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009716 *i = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00009717 MadeChange = true;
9718 } else {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009719 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
9720 GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009721 *i = Op;
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009722 MadeChange = true;
9723 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009724 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009725 }
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00009726 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009727 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
9728
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00009729 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
9730 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
9731 // real input to the dest type.
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00009732 if (GEP.hasAllZeroIndices()) {
9733 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))) {
9734 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
9735 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
9736 if (isa<AllocationInst>(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
9737 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +00009738 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
9739 if (I != BCI) {
9740 I->takeName(BCI);
9741 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
9742 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
9743 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00009744 return &GEP;
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +00009745 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00009746 }
9747 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
9748 }
9749 }
9750
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009751 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
9752 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
9753 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
9754 //
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00009755 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00009756 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00009757 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00009758
9759 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009760 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
9761 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
9762 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
9763 //
9764 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
9765 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
9766 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
9767
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00009768 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009769
9770 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
9771 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
9772 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
9773 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +00009774 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009775
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009776 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009777 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +00009778 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
9779 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
9780 //
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009781 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009782 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
9783 Sum = GO1;
9784 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
9785 Sum = SO1;
9786 } else {
9787 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
9788 // target's pointer size.
9789 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
9790 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009791 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009792 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009793 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009794 } else {
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009795 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
9796 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009797 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009798 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009799
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009800 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009801 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009802 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009803 } else {
9804 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009805 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
9806 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009807 }
9808 }
9809 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009810 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
9811 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
9812 else {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009813 Sum = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00009814 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009815 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009816 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009817
9818 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
9819 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
9820 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
9821 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
9822 return &GEP;
9823 } else {
9824 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
9825 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
9826 Indices.push_back(Sum);
9827 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
9828 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009829 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009830 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009831 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009832 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00009833 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
9834 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009835 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
9836 }
9837
9838 if (!Indices.empty())
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009839 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices.begin(),
9840 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00009841
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009842 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00009843 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
9844 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
9845
9846 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00009847 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00009848 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
9849 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
9850 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
9851
9852 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00009853 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
9854 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00009855
9856 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
9857 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
9858 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009859 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009860 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
9861 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
9862 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009863 // transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
9864 // into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009865 //
9866 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
9867 //
9868 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
9869 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
9870 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
9871 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
9872 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
9873 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
9874 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
9875 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
9876 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
9877 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
9878 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
9879 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
9880 return &GEP;
9881 }
9882 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
9883 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009884 // %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
9885 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009886 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
9887 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
9888 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009889 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
9890 TD->getABITypeSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00009891 Value *Idx[2];
9892 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
9893 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009894 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009895 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009896 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
9897 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009898 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009899
9900 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009901 // getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009902 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009903 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009904
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009905 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) && ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009906 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009907 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009908
9909 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
9910 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
9911 Value *NewIdx = 0;
9912 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
9913 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
9914 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
9915 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
9916 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6e2f8432005-09-14 17:32:56 +00009917 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009918 Scale = CI;
9919 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
9920 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
9921 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00009922 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
9923 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
9924 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009925 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
9926 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
9927 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
9928 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
9929 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
9930 }
9931 }
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009932
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009933 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009934 // out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
9935 // signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
9936 // operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
9937 if (Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
9938 Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
9939 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
9940 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009941 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009942 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009943 false /*ZExt*/);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009944 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009945 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
9946 }
9947
9948 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00009949 Value *Idx[2];
9950 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
9951 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009952 Instruction *NewGEP =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009953 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009954 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
9955 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
9956 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009957 }
9958 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009959 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009960 }
9961
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009962 return 0;
9963}
9964
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009965Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
9966 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009967 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) { // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009968 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
9969 const Type *NewTy =
9970 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00009971 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009972
9973 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
9974 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +00009975 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00009976 else {
9977 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +00009978 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00009979 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00009980
9981 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009982
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009983 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
9984 // allocas if possible...
9985 //
9986 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
9987 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
9988
9989 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
9990 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
9991 //
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009992 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00009993 Value *Idx[2];
9994 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
9995 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009996 Value *V = GetElementPtrInst::Create(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
9997 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009998
9999 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
10000 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010001 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010002 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10003 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010004 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010005 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010006
10007 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
10008 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
10009 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010010 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010011 TD->getABITypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010012 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
10013
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010014 return 0;
10015}
10016
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010017Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
10018 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
10019
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010020 // free undef -> unreachable.
10021 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
10022 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +000010023 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000010024 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010025 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10026 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010027
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010028 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
10029 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010030 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010031 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010032
10033 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
10034 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
10035 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
10036 return &FI;
10037 }
10038
10039 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
10040 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10041 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
10042 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
10043 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
10044 return &FI;
10045 }
10046 }
10047
10048 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
10049 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
10050 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
10051 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10052 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
10053 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010054
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010055 return 0;
10056}
10057
10058
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010059/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010060static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010061 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010062 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010063 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010064
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010065 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(CI)) {
10066 // Instead of loading constant c string, use corresponding integer value
10067 // directly if string length is small enough.
Evan Cheng0ff39b32008-06-30 07:31:25 +000010068 std::string Str;
10069 if (GetConstantStringInfo(CE->getOperand(0), Str) && !Str.empty()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010070 unsigned len = Str.length();
10071 const Type *Ty = cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType();
10072 unsigned numBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10073 // Replace LI with immediate integer store.
10074 if ((numBits >> 3) == len + 1) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010075 APInt StrVal(numBits, 0);
10076 APInt SingleChar(numBits, 0);
10077 if (TD->isLittleEndian()) {
10078 for (signed i = len-1; i >= 0; i--) {
10079 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10080 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10081 }
10082 } else {
10083 for (unsigned i = 0; i < len; i++) {
10084 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10085 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10086 }
10087 // Append NULL at the end.
10088 SingleChar = 0;
10089 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10090 }
10091 Value *NL = ConstantInt::get(StrVal);
10092 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, NL);
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010093 }
10094 }
10095 }
10096
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010097 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010098 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010099 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010100
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010101 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010102 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010103 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10104 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10105 // constants.
10106 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10107 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10108 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010109 Value *Idxs[2];
10110 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10111 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010112 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10113 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10114 }
10115
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010116 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010117 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +000010118 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
10119 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
10120 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010121 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10122 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010123
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010124 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
10125 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
10126 // the result of the loaded value.
10127 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
10128 CI->getName(),
10129 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
10130 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010131 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010132 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010133 }
10134 }
10135 return 0;
10136}
10137
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010138/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010139/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
10140/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
10141/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
10142static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010143 // If it is an alloca it is always safe to load from.
10144 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V)) return true;
10145
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010146 // If it is a global variable it is mostly safe to load from.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010147 if (const GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V))
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010148 // Don't try to evaluate aliases. External weak GV can be null.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010149 return !isa<GlobalAlias>(GV) && !GV->hasExternalWeakLinkage();
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010150
10151 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
10152 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010153 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
10154 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
10155 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010156 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
10157
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010158 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010159 --BBI;
10160
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010161 // If we see a free or a call (which might do a free) the pointer could be
10162 // marked invalid.
10163 if (isa<FreeInst>(BBI) || isa<CallInst>(BBI))
10164 return false;
10165
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010166 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
10167 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010168 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010169 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010170 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010171
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010172 }
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010173 return false;
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010174}
10175
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010176/// GetUnderlyingObject - Trace through a series of getelementptrs and bitcasts
10177/// until we find the underlying object a pointer is referring to or something
10178/// we don't understand. Note that the returned pointer may be offset from the
10179/// input, because we ignore GEP indices.
10180static Value *GetUnderlyingObject(Value *Ptr) {
10181 while (1) {
10182 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr)) {
10183 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast ||
10184 CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
10185 Ptr = CE->getOperand(0);
10186 else
10187 return Ptr;
10188 } else if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Ptr)) {
10189 Ptr = BCI->getOperand(0);
10190 } else if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr)) {
10191 Ptr = GEP->getOperand(0);
10192 } else {
10193 return Ptr;
10194 }
10195 }
10196}
10197
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010198Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
10199 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +000010200
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010201 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010202 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op);
10203 if (KnownAlign >
10204 (LI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(LI.getType()) :
10205 LI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010206 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10207
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010208 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010209 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010210 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010211 return Res;
10212
10213 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
10214 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010215
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010216 if (&LI.getParent()->front() != &LI) {
10217 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI; --BBI;
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +000010218 // If the instruction immediately before this is a store to the same
10219 // address, do a simple form of store->load forwarding.
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010220 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
10221 if (SI->getOperand(1) == LI.getOperand(0))
10222 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +000010223 if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI))
10224 if (LIB->getOperand(0) == LI.getOperand(0))
10225 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010226 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010227
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010228 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10229 const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
10230 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10231 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) &&
10232 cast<PointerType>(GEPI0->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010233 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10234 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10235 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10236 // CFG.
10237 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10238 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10239 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10240 }
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010241 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010242
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010243 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010244 // load null/undef -> undef
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010245 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10246 if (isa<UndefValue>(C) || (C->isNullValue() &&
10247 cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0)) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010248 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
10249 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
10250 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010251 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10252 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010253 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010254 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010255
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010256 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
10257 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010258 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010259 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010260
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010261 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010262 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010263 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
10264 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010265 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +000010266 if (Constant *V =
10267 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010268 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010269 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
10270 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10271 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10272 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10273 // CFG.
10274 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10275 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10276 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10277 }
10278
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010279 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010280 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010281 return Res;
10282 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010283 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010284 }
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010285
10286 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
10287 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
10288 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(GetUnderlyingObject(Op))) {
10289 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasInitializer()) {
10290 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
10291 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Constant::getNullValue(LI.getType()));
10292 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
10293 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10294 }
10295 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +000010296
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010297 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010298 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
10299 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
10300 // exposes redundancy in the code.
10301 //
10302 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
10303 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
10304 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
10305 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
10306 // unconditionally.
10307 //
10308 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
10309 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010310 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
10311 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010312 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010313 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010314 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010315 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010316 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010317 }
10318
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +000010319 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
10320 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
10321 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10322 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
10323 return &LI;
10324 }
10325
10326 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
10327 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
10328 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10329 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
10330 return &LI;
10331 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010332 }
10333 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010334 return 0;
10335}
10336
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +000010337/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010338/// when possible.
10339static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
10340 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
10341 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
10342
10343 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
10344 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
10345 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10346
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010347 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010348 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10349 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10350 // constants.
10351 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10352 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10353 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010354 Value* Idxs[2];
10355 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10356 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010357 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10358 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10359 }
10360
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010361 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
10362 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10363 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010364
10365 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010366 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
10367 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010368 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010369 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010370 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
10371 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
10372 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
10373 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
10374 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010375 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010376 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +000010377 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010378 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
10379 }
10380 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010381 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010382 else
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010383 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010384 CastInst::Create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010385 SI);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010386 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
10387 }
10388 }
10389 }
10390 return 0;
10391}
10392
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010393Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
10394 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
10395 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
10396
10397 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010398 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010399 ++NumCombined;
10400 return 0;
10401 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010402
10403 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
10404 // alloca dead.
Chris Lattnercea1fdd2008-04-29 04:58:38 +000010405 if (Ptr->hasOneUse() && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010406 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
10407 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10408 ++NumCombined;
10409 return 0;
10410 }
10411
10412 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
10413 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
10414 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
10415 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10416 ++NumCombined;
10417 return 0;
10418 }
10419 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010420
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010421 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010422 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr);
10423 if (KnownAlign >
10424 (SI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(Val->getType()) :
10425 SI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010426 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10427
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010428 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
10429 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
10430 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
10431 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
10432 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
10433 --ScanInsts) {
10434 --BBI;
10435
10436 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
10437 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
10438 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && PrevSI->getOperand(1) == SI.getOperand(1)) {
10439 ++NumDeadStore;
10440 ++BBI;
10441 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
10442 continue;
10443 }
10444 break;
10445 }
10446
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000010447 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
10448 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
10449 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
10450 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattnera54c7eb2007-09-07 05:33:03 +000010451 if (LI == Val && LI->getOperand(0) == Ptr && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000010452 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10453 ++NumCombined;
10454 return 0;
10455 }
10456 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
10457 // may not be dead.
10458 break;
10459 }
10460
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010461 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattner0ef546e2008-05-08 17:20:30 +000010462 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory() || BBI->mayReadFromMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010463 break;
10464 }
10465
10466
10467 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010468
10469 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
10470 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
10471 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
10472 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
10473 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010474 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010475 ++NumCombined;
10476 }
10477 return 0; // Do not modify these!
10478 }
10479
10480 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
10481 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010482 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010483 ++NumCombined;
10484 return 0;
10485 }
10486
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010487 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
10488 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010489 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010490 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
10491 return Res;
10492 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010493 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010494 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
10495 return Res;
10496
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010497
10498 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
10499 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010500 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010501 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010502 if (BI->isUnconditional())
10503 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
10504 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010505
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010506 return 0;
10507}
10508
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010509/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
10510/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
10511/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
10512///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010513/// Simplify things like:
10514/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
10515/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
10516///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010517bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
10518 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
10519
10520 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
10521 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
10522 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010523 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010524
10525 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
10526 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010527 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
10528 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010529 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010530 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010531 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010532 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010533 return false;
10534
10535 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010536 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010537 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010538 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010539 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010540 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010541 return false;
Eli Friedman66fe80a2008-06-13 21:17:49 +000010542
10543 // Bail out if all the relevant blocks aren't distinct (this can happen,
10544 // for example, if SI is in an infinite loop)
10545 if (StoreBB == DestBB || OtherBB == DestBB)
10546 return false;
10547
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010548 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
10549 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010550 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010551 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010552 return false;
10553
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010554 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
10555 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
10556 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
10557 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
10558 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
10559 --BBI;
10560 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
10561 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
10562 return false;
10563 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000010564 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010565 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
10566 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
10567 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
10568 return false;
10569
10570 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000010571 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
10572 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010573 for (;; --BBI) {
10574 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
10575 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
10576 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
10577 return false;
10578 break;
10579 }
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000010580 // If we find something that may be using or overwriting the stored
10581 // value, or if we run out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
10582 if (BBI->mayReadFromMemory() || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010583 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
10584 return false;
10585 }
10586
10587 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000010588 // make sure nothing reads or overwrites the stored value in
10589 // StoreBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010590 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
10591 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000010592 if (I->mayReadFromMemory() || I->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010593 return false;
10594 }
10595 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010596
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010597 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010598 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
10599 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010600 PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010601 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
10602 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010603 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
10604 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010605 }
10606
10607 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
10608 // insert it.
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000010609 BBI = DestBB->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010610 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
10611 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
10612
10613 // Nuke the old stores.
10614 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10615 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
10616 ++NumCombined;
10617 return true;
10618}
10619
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010620
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000010621Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
10622 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +000010623 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000010624 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
10625 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
10626 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
10627 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
10628 // Swap Destinations and condition...
10629 BI.setCondition(X);
10630 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
10631 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
10632 return &BI;
10633 }
10634
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010635 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
10636 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
10637 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
10638 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
10639 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
10640 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
10641 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010642 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010643 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
10644 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010645 // Swap Destinations and condition...
10646 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
10647 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
10648 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010649 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010650 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010651 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010652 return &BI;
10653 }
10654
10655 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
10656 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
10657 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
10658 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
10659 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
10660 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
10661 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
10662 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010663 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010664 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
10665 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000010666 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000010667 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000010668 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
10669 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010670 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010671 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010672 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000010673 return &BI;
10674 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010675
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000010676 return 0;
10677}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010678
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000010679Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
10680 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
10681 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
10682 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
10683 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
10684 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
10685 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010686 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000010687 AddRHS));
10688 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010689 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000010690 return &SI;
10691 }
10692 }
10693 return 0;
10694}
10695
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000010696Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV) {
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000010697 Value *Agg = EV.getAggregateOperand();
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000010698
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000010699 if (!EV.hasIndices())
10700 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Agg);
10701
10702 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Agg)) {
10703 if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
10704 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, UndefValue::get(EV.getType()));
10705
10706 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(C))
10707 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Constant::getNullValue(EV.getType()));
10708
10709 if (isa<ConstantArray>(C) || isa<ConstantStruct>(C)) {
10710 // Extract the element indexed by the first index out of the constant
10711 Value *V = C->getOperand(*EV.idx_begin());
10712 if (EV.getNumIndices() > 1)
10713 // Extract the remaining indices out of the constant indexed by the
10714 // first index
10715 return ExtractValueInst::Create(V, EV.idx_begin() + 1, EV.idx_end());
10716 else
10717 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, V);
10718 }
10719 return 0; // Can't handle other constants
10720 }
10721 if (InsertValueInst *IV = dyn_cast<InsertValueInst>(Agg)) {
10722 // We're extracting from an insertvalue instruction, compare the indices
10723 const unsigned *exti, *exte, *insi, *inse;
10724 for (exti = EV.idx_begin(), insi = IV->idx_begin(),
10725 exte = EV.idx_end(), inse = IV->idx_end();
10726 exti != exte && insi != inse;
10727 ++exti, ++insi) {
10728 if (*insi != *exti)
10729 // The insert and extract both reference distinctly different elements.
10730 // This means the extract is not influenced by the insert, and we can
10731 // replace the aggregate operand of the extract with the aggregate
10732 // operand of the insert. i.e., replace
10733 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
10734 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 0
10735 // with
10736 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 0
10737 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
10738 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
10739 }
10740 if (exti == exte && insi == inse)
10741 // Both iterators are at the end: Index lists are identical. Replace
10742 // %B = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
10743 // %C = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %B, 1, 0
10744 // with "i32 42"
10745 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand());
10746 if (exti == exte) {
10747 // The extract list is a prefix of the insert list. i.e. replace
10748 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
10749 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1
10750 // with
10751 // %X = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 1
10752 // %E = insertvalue { i32 } %X, i32 42, 0
10753 // by switching the order of the insert and extract (though the
10754 // insertvalue should be left in, since it may have other uses).
10755 Value *NewEV = InsertNewInstBefore(
10756 ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
10757 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end()),
10758 EV);
10759 return InsertValueInst::Create(NewEV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
10760 insi, inse);
10761 }
10762 if (insi == inse)
10763 // The insert list is a prefix of the extract list
10764 // We can simply remove the common indices from the extract and make it
10765 // operate on the inserted value instead of the insertvalue result.
10766 // i.e., replace
10767 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
10768 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1, 0
10769 // with
10770 // %E extractvalue { i32 } { i32 42 }, 0
10771 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
10772 exti, exte);
10773 }
10774 // Can't simplify extracts from other values. Note that nested extracts are
10775 // already simplified implicitely by the above (extract ( extract (insert) )
10776 // will be translated into extract ( insert ( extract ) ) first and then just
10777 // the value inserted, if appropriate).
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000010778 return 0;
10779}
10780
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010781/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
10782/// is to leave as a vector operation.
10783static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
10784 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
10785 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010786 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010787 if (isConstant) return true;
10788 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
10789 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
10790 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
10791 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
10792 return false;
10793 return true;
10794 }
10795 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
10796 if (!I) return false;
10797
10798 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
10799 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
10800 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
10801 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
10802 return true;
10803 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
10804 return true;
10805 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
10806 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
10807 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
10808 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
10809 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010810 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
10811 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
10812 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
10813 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
10814 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010815
10816 return false;
10817}
10818
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +000010819/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
10820///
10821/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
10822/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010823static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
10824 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
10825 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
10826 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
10827 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
10828 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
10829
10830 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010831 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010832 for (User::const_op_iterator i = CP->op_begin(), e = CP->op_end(); i!=e; ++i)
10833 if (isa<UndefValue>(*i))
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010834 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
10835 else
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010836 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(*i)->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010837 return Result;
10838}
10839
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010840/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
10841/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
10842/// extracted from the vector.
10843static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010844 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
10845 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000010846 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
10847 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010848 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
10849
10850 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
10851 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
10852 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
10853 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010854 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010855 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
10856 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
10857 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010858 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
10859 return 0;
10860 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010861
10862 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
10863 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010864 if (EltNo == IIElt)
10865 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010866
10867 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
10868 // vector input.
10869 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000010870 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010871 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
10872 if (InEl < Width)
10873 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
10874 else if (InEl < Width*2)
10875 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - Width);
10876 else
10877 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010878 }
10879
10880 // Otherwise, we don't know.
10881 return 0;
10882}
10883
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010884Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000010885 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000010886 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
10887 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
10888
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000010889 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000010890 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
10891 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
10892
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010893 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Matthijs Kooijmanb4d6a5a2008-06-11 09:00:12 +000010894 // If vector val is constant with all elements the same, replace EI with
10895 // that element. When the elements are not identical, we cannot replace yet
10896 // (we do that below, but only when the index is constant).
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010897 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010898 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010899 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
10900 op0 = 0;
10901 break;
10902 }
10903 if (op0)
10904 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010905 }
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010906
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010907 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
10908 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010909 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000010910 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
10911 unsigned VectorWidth =
10912 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
10913
10914 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
10915 // crashing the code below.
10916 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
10917 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
10918
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010919 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
10920 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
10921 // property.
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000010922 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010923 uint64_t UndefElts;
10924 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010925 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010926 UndefElts)) {
10927 EI.setOperand(0, V);
10928 return &EI;
10929 }
10930 }
10931
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010932 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010933 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000010934
10935 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
10936 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
10937 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
10938 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
10939 if (const VectorType *VT =
10940 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
10941 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
10942 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0), IndexVal))
10943 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
10944 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000010945 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010946
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000010947 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010948 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
10949 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
10950 // profitable to do so
10951 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010952 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
10953 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
10954 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
10955 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
10956 EI.getName()+".lhs");
10957 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
10958 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
10959 EI.getName()+".rhs");
10960 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
10961 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010962 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010963 }
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010964 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000010965 unsigned AS =
10966 cast<PointerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +000010967 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(I->getOperand(0),
10968 PointerType::get(EI.getType(), AS),EI);
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000010969 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
10970 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName()+".gep");
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010971 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
10972 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000010973 }
10974 }
10975 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
10976 // Extracting the inserted element?
10977 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
10978 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
10979 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
10980 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
10981 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
10982 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
10983 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
10984 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
10985 return &EI;
10986 }
10987 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
10988 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
10989 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010990 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
10991 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010992 Value *Src;
10993 if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements())
10994 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
10995 else if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements()*2) {
10996 SrcIdx -= SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
10997 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
10998 } else {
10999 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +000011000 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011001 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011002 }
11003 }
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011004 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011005 return 0;
11006}
11007
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011008/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
11009/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
11010/// Otherwise, return false.
11011static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
11012 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
11013 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
11014 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011015 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011016
11017 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011018 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011019 return true;
11020 } else if (V == LHS) {
11021 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011022 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011023 return true;
11024 } else if (V == RHS) {
11025 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011026 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011027 return true;
11028 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11029 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11030 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11031 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11032 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11033
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011034 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
11035 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011036 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011037
11038 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
11039 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11040 // transitively ok.
11041 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11042 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011043 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011044 return true;
11045 }
11046 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
11047 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011048 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11049 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011050 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011051
11052 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
11053 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
11054 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11055 // transitively ok.
11056 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11057 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
11058 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
11059 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011060 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011061 } else {
11062 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
11063 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011064 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011065
11066 }
11067 return true;
11068 }
11069 }
11070 }
11071 }
11072 }
11073 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
11074
11075 return false;
11076}
11077
11078/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
11079/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
11080/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011081static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011082 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011083 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011084 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011085 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011086 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011087
11088 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011089 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011090 return V;
11091 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011092 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011093 return V;
11094 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11095 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11096 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11097 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11098 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11099
11100 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11101 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11102 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11103 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011104 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
11105 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011106
11107 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
11108 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011109 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
11110 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
11111 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011112 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011113 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011114 return V;
11115 }
11116
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011117 if (VecOp == RHS) {
11118 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011119 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
11120 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
11121 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011122 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011123 }
11124 return V;
11125 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011126
11127 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
11128 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
11129 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
11130 return EI->getOperand(0);
11131
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011132 }
11133 }
11134 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011135 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011136
11137 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
11138 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011139 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011140 return V;
11141}
11142
11143Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
11144 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
11145 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
11146 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
11147
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +000011148 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
11149 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
11150 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11151
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011152 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
11153 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
11154 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11155 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11156 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
11157 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +000011158 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
11159 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011160 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011161
11162 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
11163 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11164
11165 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
11166 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
11167
11168 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
11169 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
11170 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
11171 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11172
11173 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
11174 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
11175 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
11176 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
11177 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
11178 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
11179 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
11180 // Build a new shuffle mask.
11181 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
11182 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011183 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011184 else {
11185 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011186 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011187 NumVectorElts));
11188 }
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011189 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011190 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011191 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011192 }
11193
11194 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
11195 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
11196 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
11197 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011198 Value *RHS = 0;
11199 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
11200 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
11201 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011202 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011203 }
11204 }
11205 }
11206
11207 return 0;
11208}
11209
11210
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011211Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
11212 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11213 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011214 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011215
11216 bool MadeChange = false;
11217
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011218 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011219 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011220 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
11221
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +000011222 // If we have shuffle(x, undef, mask) and any elements of mask refer to
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011223 // the undef, change them to undefs.
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +000011224 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(1))) {
11225 // Scan to see if there are any references to the RHS. If so, replace them
11226 // with undef element refs and set MadeChange to true.
11227 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11228 if (Mask[i] >= e && Mask[i] != 2*e) {
11229 Mask[i] = 2*e;
11230 MadeChange = true;
11231 }
11232 }
11233
11234 if (MadeChange) {
11235 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
11236 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11237 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11238 if (Mask[i] == 2*e)
11239 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
11240 else
11241 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
11242 }
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011243 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +000011244 }
11245 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011246
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011247 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
11248 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
11249 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
11250 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011251 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
11252 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11253 }
11254
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011255 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
11256 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11257 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011258 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011259 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011260 else {
11261 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
11262 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS)))
11263 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
11264 else
11265 Mask[i] &= (e-1); // Force to LHS.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011266 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011267 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011268 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011269 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011270 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011271 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011272 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11273 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011274 MadeChange = true;
11275 }
11276
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011277 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011278 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011279
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011280 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11281 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
11282 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
11283 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
11284
11285 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
11286 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011287 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011288
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011289 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
11290 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11291 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011292
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011293 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
11294 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
11295 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
11296 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
11297 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
11298 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
11299 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
11300 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
11301 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
11302 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
11303 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
11304 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
11305
11306 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
11307 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
11308 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
11309 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
11310 else
11311 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
11312
11313 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
11314 // the replacement.
11315 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
11316 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11317 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11318 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011319 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011320 } else {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011321 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011322 }
11323 }
11324 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
11325 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011326 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011327 }
11328 }
11329 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000011330
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011331 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
11332}
11333
11334
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011335
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011336
11337/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
11338/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
11339/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
11340/// end of its block.
11341static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
11342 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
11343
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000011344 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
Chris Lattnerbfc538c2008-05-09 15:07:33 +000011345 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory() || isa<TerminatorInst>(I))
11346 return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011347
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011348 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000011349 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
11350 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011351 return false;
11352
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011353 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
11354 // the end of block that could change the value.
Chris Lattner2539e332008-05-08 17:37:37 +000011355 if (I->mayReadFromMemory()) {
11356 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = I, E = I->getParent()->end();
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011357 Scan != E; ++Scan)
11358 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
11359 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011360 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011361
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011362 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011363
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000011364 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011365 ++NumSunkInst;
11366 return true;
11367}
11368
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011369
11370/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
11371/// all reachable code to the worklist.
11372///
11373/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
11374/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
11375/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
11376/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
11377/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
11378///
11379static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000011380 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011381 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011382 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011383 std::vector<BasicBlock*> Worklist;
11384 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011385
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011386 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11387 BB = Worklist.back();
11388 Worklist.pop_back();
11389
11390 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
11391 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
11392
11393 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
11394 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011395
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011396 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
11397 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
11398 ++NumDeadInst;
11399 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
11400 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11401 continue;
11402 }
11403
11404 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
11405 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
11406 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
11407 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
11408 ++NumConstProp;
11409 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11410 continue;
11411 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000011412
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011413 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011414 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011415
11416 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
11417 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
11418 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
11419 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
11420 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
11421 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011422 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011423 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011424 continue;
11425 }
11426 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
11427 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
11428 // See if this is an explicit destination.
11429 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
11430 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011431 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = SI->getSuccessor(i);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011432 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011433 continue;
11434 }
11435
11436 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
11437 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
11438 continue;
11439 }
11440 }
11441
11442 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
11443 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011444 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011445}
11446
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011447bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011448 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000011449 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011450
11451 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
11452 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011453
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011454 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011455 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
11456 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
11457 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000011458 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011459 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000011460
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011461 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
11462 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
11463 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
11464 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
11465 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
11466 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
11467 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
11468 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000011469
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011470 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011471 ++NumDeadInst;
11472
11473 if (!I->use_empty())
11474 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
11475 I->eraseFromParent();
11476 }
11477 }
11478 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011479
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011480 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11481 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
11482 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011483
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011484 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011485 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011486 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011487 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000011488 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011489 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011490
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011491 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000011492
11493 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011494 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011495 continue;
11496 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011497
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011498 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattner0a19ffa2007-01-30 23:16:15 +000011499 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011500 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000011501
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011502 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000011503 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +000011504 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
11505
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011506 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011507 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011508 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011509 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011510 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011511
Nick Lewycky3dfd7bf2008-05-25 20:56:15 +000011512 if (TD && I->getType()->getTypeID() == Type::VoidTyID) {
11513 // See if we can constant fold its operands.
11514 for (User::op_iterator i = I->op_begin(), e = I->op_end(); i != e; ++i) {
11515 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(i)) {
11516 if (Constant *NewC = ConstantFoldConstantExpression(CE, TD))
11517 i->set(NewC);
11518 }
11519 }
11520 }
11521
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011522 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
Dan Gohmanfc74abf2008-07-23 00:34:11 +000011523 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011524 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
11525 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
11526 if (UserParent != BB) {
11527 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
11528 // See if the user is one of our successors.
11529 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
11530 if (*SI == UserParent) {
11531 UserIsSuccessor = true;
11532 break;
11533 }
11534
11535 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
11536 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
11537 // otherwise), we can keep going.
11538 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
11539 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
11540 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
11541 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
11542 }
11543 }
11544
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011545 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000011546#ifndef NDEBUG
11547 std::string OrigI;
11548#endif
11549 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011550 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000011551 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011552 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000011553 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011554 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
11555 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000011556
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011557 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
11558 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
11559
11560 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011561 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011562 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011563
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011564 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
11565 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011566
11567 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
11568 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000011569 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
11570
11571 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
11572 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
11573 ++InsertPos;
11574
11575 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011576
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000011577 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
11578 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011579 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner216d4d82004-05-01 23:19:52 +000011580
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011581 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
11582 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011583 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011584
11585 // Erase the old instruction.
11586 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000011587 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000011588#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000011589 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
11590 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000011591#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000011592
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011593 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
11594 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000011595 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
11596 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
11597 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011598 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011599
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000011600 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011601 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011602 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011603 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011604 } else {
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011605 AddToWorkList(I);
11606 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011607 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000011608 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011609 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011610 }
11611 }
11612
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011613 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +000011614
11615 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
11616 WorklistMap.clear();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011617 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000011618}
11619
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011620
11621bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000011622 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
11623
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011624 bool EverMadeChange = false;
11625
11626 // Iterate while there is work to do.
11627 unsigned Iteration = 0;
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000011628 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011629 EverMadeChange = true;
11630 return EverMadeChange;
11631}
11632
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000011633FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011634 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000011635}
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000011636